blob: 7d23f48516f26b71b18a2b1a07be3114eaf493b7 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau33205c22020-07-07 16:35:28 +02005 version 2.3
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreauf104b532020-08-14 18:54:05 +02007 2020/08/14
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020057
584. Proxies
594.1. Proxy keywords matrix
604.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
61
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100625. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200635.1. Bind options
645.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200655.3. Server DNS resolution
665.3.1. Global overview
675.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020068
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100696. Cache
706.1. Limitation
716.2. Setup
726.2.1. Cache section
736.2.2. Proxy section
74
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200757. Using ACLs and fetching samples
767.1. ACL basics
777.1.1. Matching booleans
787.1.2. Matching integers
797.1.3. Matching strings
807.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
817.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
827.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
837.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
847.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200857.3.1. Converters
867.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
877.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
887.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
897.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
907.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200917.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093
948. Logging
958.1. Log levels
968.2. Log formats
978.2.1. Default log format
988.2.2. TCP log format
998.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001008.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001018.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001028.3. Advanced logging options
1038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1048.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1078.4. Timing events
1088.5. Session state at disconnection
1098.6. Non-printable characters
1108.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1128.9. Examples of logs
113
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001149. Supported filters
1159.1. Trace
1169.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001179.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001189.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001199.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200120
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012110. FastCGI applications
12210.1. Setup
12310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12410.1.2. Proxy section
12510.1.3. Example
12610.2. Default parameters
12710.3. Limitations
128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129
1301. Quick reminder about HTTP
131----------------------------
132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
135on almost anything found in the contents.
136
137However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
138formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
139correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
140
141
1421.1. The HTTP transaction model
143-------------------------------
144
145The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100146to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100147from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
148connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149will involve a new connection :
150
151 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
152
153In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
154establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
155by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
156length.
157
158Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
159to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
160however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
161response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
162header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
167power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
168but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
173second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
174page :
175
176 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
177
178This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
179latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
180correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
181the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100182server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100184The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
185time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
186are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
187parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
188carry the stream identifier.
189
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
191connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
192leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
194processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
195waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200197HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
199 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100200 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200202 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100203
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100204
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205
2061.2. HTTP request
207-----------------
208
209First, let's consider this HTTP request :
210
211 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100212 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
214 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
215 3 User-agent: my small browser
216 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
217 5 Accept: image/png
218
219
2201.2.1. The Request line
221-----------------------
222
223Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
224
225 - a METHOD : GET
226 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
227 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
228
229All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
230which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
231followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
232is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
233desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
234the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
235
236The URI itself can have several forms :
237
238 - A "relative URI" :
239
240 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
243 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
244
245 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
246
247 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
250 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
251 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
252 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
253 must accept this form too.
254
255 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
256 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
257 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100258
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200259 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
260 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
261 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
262 other protocols too.
263
264In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
265mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
266on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
267It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
268specific to the language, framework or application in use.
269
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100270HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100271assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200273
2741.2.2. The request headers
275--------------------------
276
277The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
278beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
279an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
280Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
281values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
282encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
283the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
284define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
285
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100286Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100288"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200289as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
290normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
291representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
292HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293
294The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
295that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
296is one valid form of empty line.
297
298Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
299headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
300about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
301application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
302
303Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000304 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200305 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
306 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
307 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
308
309
3101.3. HTTP response
311------------------
312
313An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
314messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
315
316 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100317 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200318 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
319 2 Content-length: 350
320 3 Content-Type: text/html
321
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200322As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
323codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
324response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100325continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
326the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
327following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
328sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
329(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
330correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
331such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
332state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
333over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
334if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
335information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200336
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200337
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003381.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200339------------------------
340
341Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
342
343 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
344 - a status code : 200
345 - a reason : OK
346
347The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100348 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
349 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
350 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
351 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
352 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200353
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000354Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100355"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
357messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
358or "Authentication Required".
359
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100360HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
362 Code When / reason
363 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
364 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
365 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
366 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100367 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
368 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200369 400 for an invalid or too large request
370 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
371 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200372 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100373 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100375 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
376 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
378 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
379 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
382 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
383 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
384
385The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3864.2).
387
388
3891.3.2. The response headers
390---------------------------
391
392Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
393the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
394details.
395
396
3972. Configuring HAProxy
398----------------------
399
4002.1. Configuration file format
401------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200402
403HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
404
405 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
406 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
407 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
408 "frontend" and "backend".
409
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100410The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
411referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200414
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004152.2. Quoting and escaping
416-------------------------
417
418HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
419many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
420with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
421single quotes.
422
423If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
424them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
425escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
426
427Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
428
429 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
430 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
431 \\ to use a backslash
432 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
433 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
434
435Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
436the interpretation of:
437
438 space as a parameter separator
439 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
440 # hash as a comment start
441
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200442Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
443-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
444backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
445
446Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200447quoting.
448
449Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
450nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
451
452Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
453equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
454
455 Example:
456 # those are equivalents:
457 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
458 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
459 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
460 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
461 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
462
463 # those are equivalents:
464 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
465 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
466 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
467 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
468
469
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004702.3. Environment variables
471--------------------------
472
473HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
474interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
475configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
476optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
477shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
478underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
479
480 Example:
481
482 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
483
484 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
485
486 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
487
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200488Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
489file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200490
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200491* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
492 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
493
494* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
495 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
496 directory.
497
498* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
499
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500500* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200501 processes, separated by semicolons.
502
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500503* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200504 CLI, separated by semicolons.
505
506See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200507
5082.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200509----------------
510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100511Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100512values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
513otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
514numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
515for every keyword. Supported units are :
516
517 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
518 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
519 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
520 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
521 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
522 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
523
524
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005252.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200526-------------
527
528 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
529 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
530 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
531 global
532 daemon
533 maxconn 256
534
535 defaults
536 mode http
537 timeout connect 5000ms
538 timeout client 50000ms
539 timeout server 50000ms
540
541 frontend http-in
542 bind *:80
543 default_backend servers
544
545 backend servers
546 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
547
548
549 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
550 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
551 global
552 daemon
553 maxconn 256
554
555 defaults
556 mode http
557 timeout connect 5000ms
558 timeout client 50000ms
559 timeout server 50000ms
560
561 listen http-in
562 bind *:80
563 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
564
565
566Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
567
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100568 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200569
570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005713. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200572--------------------
573
574Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
575are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
576of them have command-line equivalents.
577
578The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
579
580 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200581 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200582 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200583 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200584 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200585 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200586 - description
587 - deviceatlas-json-file
588 - deviceatlas-log-level
589 - deviceatlas-separator
590 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900591 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200592 - gid
593 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100594 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200595 - h1-case-adjust
596 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100597 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100598 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100599 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200600 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200601 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200602 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100603 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200604 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100605 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200606 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200607 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200608 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200609 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200610 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200611 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100612 - presetenv
613 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614 - uid
615 - ulimit-n
616 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200617 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100618 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200619 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200620 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200621 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200622 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-options
624 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200625 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - ssl-default-server-options
627 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100628 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200629 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100630 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100631 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100632 - 51degrees-data-file
633 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200634 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200635 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200636 - wurfl-data-file
637 - wurfl-information-list
638 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200639 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100640 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100641
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100643 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200644 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200646 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100647 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100648 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100649 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200650 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200651 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200652 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200653 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200654 - noepoll
655 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000656 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100658 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300659 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000660 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100661 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200662 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200663 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200664 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000665 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000666 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200667 - tune.buffers.limit
668 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200669 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200670 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100671 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200672 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200673 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200674 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200675 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100676 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200677 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200678 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200679 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100680 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100681 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100682 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100683 - tune.lua.session-timeout
684 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200685 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100686 - tune.maxaccept
687 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200688 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200689 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200690 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200691 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
692 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100693 - tune.rcvbuf.client
694 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100695 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200696 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200697 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100698 - tune.sndbuf.client
699 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100700 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +0200701 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100702 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200703 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100704 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200705 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200706 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100707 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200708 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100709 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200710 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
711 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
712 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100713 - tune.zlib.memlevel
714 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100715
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200716 * Debugging
717 - debug
718 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200719 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200720
721
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007223.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723------------------------------------
724
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200725ca-base <dir>
726 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100727 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
728 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
729 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200730
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200731chroot <jail dir>
732 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
733 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
734 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
735 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
736 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100737 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100738
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100739cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
740 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
741 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
742 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
743 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
744 set. These sets have the format
745
746 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
747
748 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100749 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100750 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
751 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100752 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
753 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100754 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100755 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100756 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100757 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100758 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
759 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
760 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
761 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100762
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100763 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
764 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
765 on the machine's word size.
766
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100767 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100768 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
769 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
770 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
771 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
772 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
773 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100774
775 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100776 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
777
778 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
779 # first 4 CPUs
780
781 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
782 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
783 # word size.
784
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100785 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100786 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100787 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
788 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
789 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
790
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100791 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
792 # and so on.
793 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
794 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
795 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
796
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100797 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100798 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
799 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
800 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
801
802 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
803 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
804 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
805
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100806 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
807 # and a thread range.
808 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
809 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
810 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
811
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200812crt-base <dir>
813 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100814 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
815 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200816
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200817daemon
818 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
819 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100820 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
821 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200822
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200823deviceatlas-json-file <path>
824 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100825 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200826
827deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100828 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200829 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
830
831deviceatlas-separator <char>
832 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
833 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
834
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100835deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200836 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
837 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
838 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100839
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900840external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100841 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
842 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100843 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
844 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
845 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
846 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
847 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900848
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200849gid <number>
850 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
851 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
852 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100853 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
854 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200855 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100856
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100857group <group name>
858 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
859 See also "gid" and "user".
860
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100861hard-stop-after <time>
862 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
863
864 Arguments :
865 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
866 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
867 SIGUSR1 signal.
868
869 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
870 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
871 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
872
873 Example:
874 global
875 hard-stop-after 30s
876
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200877h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
878 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
879 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
880 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
881 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500882 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200883 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
884 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
885 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
886 specified in a proxy.
887
888 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
889 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
890 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
891 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
892 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
893 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
894 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
895
896 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
897 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
898 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
899 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
900 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
901
902 Example:
903 global
904 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
905
906 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
907 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
908
909h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
910 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
911 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
912 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
913 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
914 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
915 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
916 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
917 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
918
919 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
920 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
921 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
922
923 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
924 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
925
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100926insecure-fork-wanted
927 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
928 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
929 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
930 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
931 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
932 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
933 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
934 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
935 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
936 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
937 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
938 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
939 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
940 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
941 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
942 disable it.
943
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100944insecure-setuid-wanted
945 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
946 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
947 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
948 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
949 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
950 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
951 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
952 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
953 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
954 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
955 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
956 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
957 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
958 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
959
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100960issuers-chain-path <dir>
961 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
962 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
963 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
964 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
965 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
966 "issuers-chain-path".
967 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
968 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
969 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
970 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
971 will share the chain in memory.
972
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200973localpeer <name>
974 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
975 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
976 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
977 the configuration parsing.
978
979 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
980 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
981
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200982log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
983 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100984 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100985 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100986 configured with "log global".
987
988 <address> can be one of:
989
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100990 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100991 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
992 port).
993
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100994 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
995 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
996 port).
997
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100998 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100999 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1000 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001001 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001002
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001003 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1004 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1005 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1006 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1007 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1008 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1009 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1010 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1011 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1012 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1013 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1014 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1015 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1016 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001017 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1018 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001019
1020 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1021 "fd@2", see above.
1022
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001023 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1024 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1025 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1026 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1027 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1028
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001029 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1030 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001031
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001032 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1033 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1034 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1035 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1036 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1037 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1038 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1039 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1040 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1041 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001042 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1043 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001044
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001045 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1046 one of the following :
1047
1048 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1049 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1050
1051 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1052 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1053
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001054 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1055 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1056 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1057 designed to be used with a local log server.
1058
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001059 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1060 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1061 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1062 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1063 logger consumes.
1064
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001065 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1066 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1067 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1068 used with a local log server.
1069
1070 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1071 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1072 designed to be used with a local log server.
1073
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001074 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1075 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1076 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1077 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1078
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001079 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1080 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1081 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1082 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1083 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1084
1085 <sample_size>
1086 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1087 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1088 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1089 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1090 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1091
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001092 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001093
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001094 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1095 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1096 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1097
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001098 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1099 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1100 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1101 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001102
1103 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001104 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1105 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1106 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1107 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1108 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1109 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001110
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001111 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001112
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001113log-send-hostname [<string>]
1114 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1115 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1116 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1117 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1118 the logs.
1119
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001120log-tag <string>
1121 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1122 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1123 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001124 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001125
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001126lua-load <file>
1127 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1128 used multiple times.
1129
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001130lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1131 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1132 variable.
1133 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1134 to "path".
1135
1136 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1137 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1138 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1139 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1140 will be checked earlier.
1141
1142 As an example by specifying the following path:
1143
1144 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1145 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1146
1147 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1148 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1149 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1150 paths if that does not exist either.
1151
1152 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1153 documentation.
1154
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001155master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001156 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1157 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1158 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001159 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001160 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1161 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001162 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1163 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1164 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1165 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1166 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001167
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001168 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001169
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001170mworker-max-reloads <number>
1171 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001172 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001173 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1174 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1175 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1176
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001177nbproc <number>
1178 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1179 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1180 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001181 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1182 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001183 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1184 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001185
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001186nbthread <number>
1187 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001188 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1189 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1190 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1191 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1192 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001193 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1194 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1195 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1196 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1197 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1198 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1199 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001200
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001201pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001202 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1203 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1204 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1205 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001206
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001207pp2-never-send-local
1208 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1209 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1210 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1211 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1212 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1213 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1214 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1215 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1216 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1217 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1218 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1219
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001220presetenv <name> <value>
1221 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1222 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1223 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1224 and "unsetenv".
1225
1226resetenv [<name> ...]
1227 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1228 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1229 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1230 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1231 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1232 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1233 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1234 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1235
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001236stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001237 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1238 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1239 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1240 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1241 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1242 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001243 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001244 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1245 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1246 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1247 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001248
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001249server-state-base <directory>
1250 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001251 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1252 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001253
1254server-state-file <file>
1255 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1256 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1257 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1258 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1259 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1260 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1261 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1262 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001263 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1264 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001265
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001266setenv <name> <value>
1267 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1268 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1269 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1270 and "unsetenv".
1271
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001272set-dumpable
1273 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001274 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1275 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1276 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1277 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1278 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1279 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1280 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1281 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1282 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1283 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1284 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1285 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1286 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1287 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1288 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1289 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1290 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001291
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001292ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1293 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1294 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001295 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001296 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001297 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1298 information and recommendations see e.g.
1299 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1300 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1301 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1302 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001303
1304ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1305 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1306 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1307 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1308 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1309 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001310 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1311 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1312 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001313 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001314
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001315ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1316 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1317 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1318 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1319 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1320 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1321
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001322ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1323 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1324 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1325 keyword to see available options.
1326
1327 Example:
1328 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001329 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001330
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001331ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1332 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1333 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001334 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001335 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001336 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1337 information and recommendations see e.g.
1338 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1339 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1340 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1341 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1342 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001343
1344ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1345 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1346 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1347 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1348 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1349 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001350 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1351 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1352 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1353 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001354
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001355ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1356 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1357 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1358 keyword to see available options.
1359
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001360ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1361 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1362 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1363 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001364 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001365 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001366 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1367 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1368 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1369 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001370 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1371 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1372 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1373
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001374ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001375 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1376 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1377
1378 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1379 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1380 optimize the startup time.
1381
1382 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1383 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1384 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1385
1386 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001387 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001388
1389 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1390 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1391 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1392 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1393 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1394 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001395 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specify both the ECDSA
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001396 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1397
1398 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1399
1400 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1401
1402 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1403 not provided in the PEM file.
1404
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001405 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1406 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1407
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001408 The default behavior is "all".
1409
1410 Example:
1411 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1412 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1413 ssl-load-extra-files none
1414
1415 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1416
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001417ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1418 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1419 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1420 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1421
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001422ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001423 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001424 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1425 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1426 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1427 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1428 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1429 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001430 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001431
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001432stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1433 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1434 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1435 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001436 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001437 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001438
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001439 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1440 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1441 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001442
1443stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1444 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1445 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001446 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001447
1448stats maxconn <connections>
1449 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1450 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1451
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001452uid <number>
1453 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1454 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1455 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1456 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1457
1458ulimit-n <number>
1459 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1460 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1461 option.
1462
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001463unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1464 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1465
1466 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1467 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1468 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1469 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1470 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1471 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1472 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1473 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1474 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1475 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1476
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001477unsetenv [<name> ...]
1478 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1479 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1480 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1481 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1482 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1483 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1484 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1485
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001486user <user name>
1487 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1488 See also "uid" and "group".
1489
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001490node <name>
1491 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1492
1493 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1494 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1495 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1496 traffic.
1497
1498description <text>
1499 Add a text that describes the instance.
1500
1501 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1502 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1503 "<" and ">" characters.
1504
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100150551degrees-data-file <file path>
1506 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001507 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001508
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001509 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001510 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1511
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000151251degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001513 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1514 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1515 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1516
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001517 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001518 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1519
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200152051degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001521 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1522 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1523
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001524 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1525 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1526
152751degrees-cache-size <number>
1528 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1529 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1530 By default, this cache is disabled.
1531
1532 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001533 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1534
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001535wurfl-data-file <file path>
1536 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1537 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1538
1539 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1540 with USE_WURFL=1.
1541
1542wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1543 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1544 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1545 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1546
1547 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1548
1549 Valid WURFL properties are:
1550 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1551
1552 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1553 device.
1554
1555 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1556 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1557
1558 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1559 particular web request.
1560
1561 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1562 used Libwurfl API version.
1563
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001564 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1565 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1566
1567 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1568 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1569
1570 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1571
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001572 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1573 with USE_WURFL=1.
1574
1575wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1576 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1577 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1578
1579 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1580 with USE_WURFL=1.
1581
1582wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1583 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1584 thus before the chroot.
1585
1586 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1587 with USE_WURFL=1.
1588
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001589wurfl-cache-size <size>
1590 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1591 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001592 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001593 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001594
1595 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1596 with USE_WURFL=1.
1597
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001598strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001599 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1600 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
1601 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
1602 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
1603 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001604
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016053.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001606-----------------------
1607
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001608busy-polling
1609 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1610 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1611 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1612 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1613 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1614 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1615 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1616 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1617 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1618 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1619 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1620 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1621 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1622 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1623 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1624 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1625 "poll" pollers.
1626
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001627 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1628 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1629 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1630
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001631max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1632 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1633 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1634 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1635 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1636 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1637 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1638 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1639 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1640
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001641maxconn <number>
1642 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1643 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1644 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001645 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1646 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1647 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1648 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001649 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1650 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1651 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1652 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1653 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1654 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001655
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001656maxconnrate <number>
1657 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1658 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1659 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1660 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1661 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1662 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1663 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1664 fairness.
1665
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001666maxcomprate <number>
1667 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001668 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001669 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1670 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1671 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001672 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001673 default value.
1674
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001675maxcompcpuusage <number>
1676 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1677 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1678 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1679 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1680 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1681 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1682 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1683 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1684
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001685maxpipes <number>
1686 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1687 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1688 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1689 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1690 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1691 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1692
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001693maxsessrate <number>
1694 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1695 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1696 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1697 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1698 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1699 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1700 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1701 fairness.
1702
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001703maxsslconn <number>
1704 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1705 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1706 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1707 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1708 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1709 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1710 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001711 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1712 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1713 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1714 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1715 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1716 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1717 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001718
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001719maxsslrate <number>
1720 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1721 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1722 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1723 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1724 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1725 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1726 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1727 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1728 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1729 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1730
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001731maxzlibmem <number>
1732 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1733 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1734 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001735 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1736 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1737 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1738
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001739noepoll
1740 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1741 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001742 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001743
1744nokqueue
1745 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1746 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1747 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1748
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001749noevports
1750 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1751 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1752 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1753 also "nopoll".
1754
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001755nopoll
1756 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1757 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001758 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001759 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1760 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001761
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001762nosplice
1763 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001764 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001765 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001766 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001767 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1768 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1769 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1770 "option splice-response".
1771
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001772nogetaddrinfo
1773 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1774 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1775
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001776noreuseport
1777 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1778 command line argument "-dR".
1779
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001780profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1781 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1782 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1783 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1784 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001785 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001786 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1787 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1788 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1789 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1790
1791 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1792 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1793 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1794 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1795 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001796 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1797 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1798 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1799 CLI.
1800
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001801spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001802 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1803 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1804 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1805 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1806 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1807 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001808
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001809ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001810 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001811 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001812 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1813 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1814 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1815 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1816 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001817 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1818 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001819 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1820 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1821 openssl configuration file uses:
1822 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1823
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001824ssl-mode-async
1825 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001826 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001827 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1828 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1829 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001830 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001831 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001832
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001833tune.buffers.limit <number>
1834 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1835 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1836 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1837 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1838 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001839 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001840 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1841 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1842 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1843 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1844 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1845 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1846 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1847 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1848 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1849
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001850tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1851 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1852 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1853 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1854 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1855
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001856tune.bufsize <number>
1857 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1858 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1859 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1860 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1861 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1862 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1863 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001864 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1865 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1866 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001867 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001868 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1869 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1870 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001871
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001872tune.chksize <number>
1873 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1874 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1875 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1876 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1877 checks whenever possible.
1878
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001879tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1880 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1881 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1882 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1883 this value. The default value is 1.
1884
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001885tune.fail-alloc
1886 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1887 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1888 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1889 gracefully.
1890
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001891tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
1892 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
1893 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
1894 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
1895 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
1896 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
1897
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001898tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1899 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1900 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1901 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1902 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1903 change it.
1904
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001905tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1906 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001907 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1908 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001909 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1910 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1911 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1912 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1913 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1914
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001915tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1916 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1917 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1918 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1919 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1920 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1921 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1922 recommended not to change this value.
1923
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001924tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1925 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1926 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1927 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1928 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1929 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1930 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1931 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1932
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001933tune.http.cookielen <number>
1934 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1935 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1936 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1937 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1938 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1939 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1940 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1941 to change this value.
1942
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001943tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001944 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1945 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001946 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001947 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001948 configuration directives too.
1949 The default value is 1024.
1950
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001951tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1952 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1953 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1954 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1955 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1956 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1957 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001958 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1959 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1960 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001961
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001962tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
1963 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
1964 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
1965 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
1966 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
1967 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
1968 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
1969 this option to "off". The default is on.
1970
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001971tune.idletimer <timeout>
1972 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1973 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1974 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1975 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1976 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1977 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001978 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001979 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001980 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1981
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001982tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1983 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1984 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1985 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1986 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1987 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1988 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1989 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1990 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1991 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1992
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001993tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1994 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001995 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001996 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1997 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001998 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001999 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2000 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2001
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002002tune.lua.maxmem
2003 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2004 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2005 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2006 memory.
2007
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002008tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2009 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002010 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2011 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002012 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002013
2014tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2015 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2016 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2017 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2018 check servers.
2019
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002020tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2021 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2022 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2023 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002024 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002025
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002026tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002027 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2028 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2029 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2030 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2031 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2032 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2033 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2034 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2035 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2036 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002037
2038tune.maxpollevents <number>
2039 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2040 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2041 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2042 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2043 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2044
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002045tune.maxrewrite <number>
2046 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2047 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2048 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2049 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2050 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2051 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2052 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2053 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2054 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2055 bufsize.
2056
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002057tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2058 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2059 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2060 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2061 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2062 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2063 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2064 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2065 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2066 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002067 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2068 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002069 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2070 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2071 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2072 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2073 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2074 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2075 setting this parameter to 0.
2076
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002077tune.pipesize <number>
2078 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2079 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2080 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2081 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2082 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2083 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2084
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002085tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2086 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2087 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2088 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2089 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2090 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2091 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002092 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002093
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002094tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2095 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2096 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2097 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2098 default is 20.
2099
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002100tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2101tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2102 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2103 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2104 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002105 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002106 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002107 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2108 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2109
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002110tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002111 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002112 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2113 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2114 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2115 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2116
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002117tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002118 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002119 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002120 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2121 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2122 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2123
2124tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2125 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2126 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2127 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2128 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2129 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2130 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2131 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2132 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2133 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002134
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002135tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2136tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2137 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2138 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2139 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002140 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002141 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002142 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2143 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2144 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2145 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2146 notifying haproxy again.
2147
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002148tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002149 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2150 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2151 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002152 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002153 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002154 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002155 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2156 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2157 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002158 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2159 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002160
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002161tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002162 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002163 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2164 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2165 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2166 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2167 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2168
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002169tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2170 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2171 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2172 performances. This is disabled by default.
2173
2174 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2175 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2176
2177 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2178
2179 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2180
2181 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2182
2183 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2184 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2185 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2186
2187 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2188 converted.
2189
2190 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2191 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2192 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2193 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2194 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2195 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2196 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002197 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2198 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002199
2200 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2201
2202 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2203 only need this line:
2204
2205 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2206
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002207tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2208 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002209 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002210 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2211 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2212 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2213 being used for too long.
2214
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002215tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2216 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2217 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2218 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2219 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2220 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2221 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2222 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2223 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2224 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2225 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002226 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002227 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002228
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002229tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2230 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2231 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2232 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2233 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002234 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002235 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2236 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002237 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2238 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002239
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002240tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2241 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2242 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2243 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2244 1000 entries.
2245
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002246tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2247 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2248 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2249 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2250
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002251tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002252tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002253tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2254tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2255tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002256 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2257 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2258 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2259 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2260 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2261 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2262 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2263 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002264
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002265 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2266 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2267 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2268 all available space is consumed.
2269 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2270 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2271 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002272
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002273tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2274 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002275 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002276 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002277 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002278 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2279
2280tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2281 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2282 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002283 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2284 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002285
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022863.3. Debugging
2287--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002288
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002289debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002290 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2291 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2292 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2293 system startup.
2294
2295quiet
2296 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2297 line argument "-q".
2298
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002299zero-warning
2300 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2301 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2302 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2303 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2304 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2305 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2306
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002307
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010023083.4. Userlists
2309--------------
2310It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2311http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2312it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2313
2314userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002315 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002316 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2317
2318group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002319 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002320 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2321 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2322
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002323user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2324 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002325 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2326 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002327 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2328 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2329 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2330 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002331
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002332 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2333 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2334 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2335 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2336 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2337 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2338 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2339 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2340 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002341
2342 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002343 userlist L1
2344 group G1 users tiger,scott
2345 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002346
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002347 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2348 user scott insecure-password elgato
2349 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002350
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002351 userlist L2
2352 group G1
2353 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002354
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002355 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2356 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2357 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002358
2359 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002360
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002361
23623.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002363----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002364It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2365several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2366instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2367values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2368automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2369In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2370using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2371tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2372reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2373Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2374that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2375each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002376
2377peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002378 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002379 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2380
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002381bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2382 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2383 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2384
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002385disabled
2386 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2387 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2388 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2389
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002390default-bind [param*]
2391 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2392
2393default-server [param*]
2394 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2395
2396 Arguments:
2397 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2398 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2399 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2400 details.
2401
2402
2403 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2404
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002405enable
2406 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2407
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002408log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2409 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2410 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2411 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2412 more details.
2413
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002414peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002415 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2416 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002417 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2418 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2419 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2420 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2421 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002422
2423 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2424 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2425
2426 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002427 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2428 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2429 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002430
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002431 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2432 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002433
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002434 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2435 "server" keyword explanation below).
2436
2437server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002438 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002439 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2440 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2441 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2442 of this "peers" section).
2443 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2444
2445
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002446 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002447 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002448 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002449 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2450 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2451 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002452
2453 backend mybackend
2454 mode tcp
2455 balance roundrobin
2456 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2457 stick on src
2458
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002459 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2460 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002461
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002462 Example:
2463 peers mypeers
2464 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2465 default-server ssl verify none
2466 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2467 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002468
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002469
2470table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2471 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2472
2473 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2474 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002475 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002476 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2477 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2478 "stick-table" keyword).
2479
2480 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2481 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2482 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2483 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2484 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2485 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2486 of the stick-table name as follows:
2487
2488 peers mypeers
2489 peer A ...
2490 peer B ...
2491 table t1 ...
2492
2493 frontend fe1
2494 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2495
2496 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2497 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2498
2499 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2500 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2501 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2502 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2503 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2504 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2505 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2506
2507 peers mypeers
2508 peer A ...
2509 peer B ...
2510 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2511
2512 backend t1
2513 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2514
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002515 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002516 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2517 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2518
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090025193.6. Mailers
2520------------
2521It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2522If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2523in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2524
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002525mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002526 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2527 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2528
2529mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2530 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2531
2532 Example:
2533 mailers mymailers
2534 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2535 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2536
2537 backend mybackend
2538 mode tcp
2539 balance roundrobin
2540
2541 email-alert mailers mymailers
2542 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2543 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2544
2545 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2546 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2547
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002548timeout mail <time>
2549 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2550 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2551 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2552 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2553
2554 Example:
2555 mailers mymailers
2556 timeout mail 20s
2557 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002558
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020025593.7. Programs
2560-------------
2561In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2562master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2563managed the same way as the workers.
2564
2565During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2566sequence as a worker:
2567
2568 - the master is re-executed
2569 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2570 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2571 instance of the program
2572
2573During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2574
2575program <name>
2576 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2577 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2578 the management guide).
2579
2580command <command> [arguments*]
2581 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2582 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2583 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2584 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2585
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002586user <user name>
2587 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2588 See also "group".
2589
2590group <group name>
2591 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2592 See also "user".
2593
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002594option start-on-reload
2595no option start-on-reload
2596 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2597 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2598 program section.
2599
2600
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010026013.8. HTTP-errors
2602----------------
2603
2604It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2605imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2606several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2607
2608http-errors <name>
2609 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2610 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2611
2612errorfile <code> <file>
2613 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2614
2615 Arguments :
2616 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002617 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2618 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002619
2620 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2621 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2622 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2623 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2624 before any chroot is performed.
2625
2626 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2627
2628 Example:
2629 http-errors website-1
2630 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2631 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2632 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2633
2634 http-errors website-2
2635 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2636 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2637 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2638
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020026393.9. Rings
2640----------
2641
2642It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2643servers or traces.
2644
2645ring <ringname>
2646 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2647
2648description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002649 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002650 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2651
2652format <format>
2653 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2654
2655 Arguments:
2656 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2657 one of the following :
2658
2659 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2660 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2661 designed to be used with a local log server.
2662
2663 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2664 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2665 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2666 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2667 is the default.
2668
2669 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
2670 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2671
2672 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2673 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2674
2675 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2676 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2677 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2678 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2679 logger consumes.
2680
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02002681 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
2682 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
2683 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
2684 with a local log server.
2685
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002686 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2687 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2688 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2689 used with a local log server.
2690
2691maxlen <length>
2692 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2693 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2694 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2695
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002696server <name> <address> [param*]
2697 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2698 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2699 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2700 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2701 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2702 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2703 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2704 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2705 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002706 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2707 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002708
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002709size <size>
2710 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2711 set to BUFSIZE.
2712
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002713timeout connect <timeout>
2714 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2715
2716 Arguments :
2717 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2718 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2719 as explained at the top of this document.
2720
2721timeout server <timeout>
2722 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
2723
2724 Arguments :
2725 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2726 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2727 as explained at the top of this document.
2728
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002729 Example:
2730 global
2731 log ring@myring local7
2732
2733 ring myring
2734 description "My local buffer"
2735 format rfc3164
2736 maxlen 1200
2737 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002738 timeout connect 5s
2739 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002740 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002741
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020027423.10. Log forwarding
2743-------------------
2744
2745It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
2746haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
2747
2748log-forward <name>
2749 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
2750
2751bind <addr> [param*]
2752 Used to configure a log udp listener to receive messages to forward.
2753 Only udp listeners are allowed, address must be prefixed using
2754 'udp@', 'udp4@' or 'udp6@'. This supports for all "bind" parameters
2755 found in 5.1 paragraph but most of them are irrelevant for udp/syslog case.
2756
2757log global
2758log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2759 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2760 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
2761 documentation.
2762 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
2763 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
2764 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
2765 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
2766 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
2767
2768 Example:
2769 global
2770 log stderr format iso local7
2771
2772 ring myring
2773 description "My local buffer"
2774 format rfc5424
2775 maxlen 1200
2776 size 32764
2777 timeout connect 5s
2778 timeout server 10s
2779 # syslog tcp server
2780 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
2781
2782 log-forward sylog-loadb
2783 bind udp4@127.0.0.1:1514
2784 # all messages on stderr
2785 log global
2786 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
2787 log ring@myring local0
2788 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
2789 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
2790 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
2791 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
2792 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002793
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027944. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002795----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002796
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002797Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002798 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002799 - frontend <name>
2800 - backend <name>
2801 - listen <name>
2802
2803A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2804its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2805section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002806section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002807
2808A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2809connections.
2810
2811A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2812to forward incoming connections.
2813
2814A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2815parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2816
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002817All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2818'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2819case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2820
2821Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2822logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2823proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2824However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2825name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2826
2827Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2828and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002829bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002830protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2831modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2832arbitrary criteria.
2833
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002834In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2835a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002836the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002837
2838 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2839 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2840 between responses and new requests.
2841
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002842 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2843 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2844 client-facing connection remains open.
2845
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002846 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2847 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002848
2849The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2850frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2851following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002852weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002853
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002854 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002855
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002856 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2857 ----+-----+-----+----
2858 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2859 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002860 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2861 ----+-----+-----+----
2862 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002863
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002864
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002865
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028664.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2867--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002868
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002869The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2870limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2871they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2872limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002873marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002874option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002875and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2876with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2877specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002878
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002879
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002880 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2881------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2882acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002883backlog X X X -
2884balance X - X X
2885bind - X X -
2886bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002887capture cookie - X X -
2888capture request header - X X -
2889capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09002890clitcpka-cnt X X X -
2891clitcpka-idle X X X -
2892clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002893compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002894cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002895declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002896default-server X - X X
2897default_backend X X X -
2898description - X X X
2899disabled X X X X
2900dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002901email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002902email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002903email-alert mailers X X X X
2904email-alert myhostname X X X X
2905email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002906enabled X X X X
2907errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002908errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002909errorloc X X X X
2910errorloc302 X X X X
2911-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2912errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002913force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002914filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002915fullconn X - X X
2916grace X X X X
2917hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002918http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002919http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002920http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002921http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002922http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02002923http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002924http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002925http-check set-var X - X X
2926http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02002927http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002928http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002929http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002930http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002931http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002932id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002933ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002934load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002935log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002936log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002937log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002938log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002939max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002940maxconn X X X -
2941mode X X X X
2942monitor fail - X X -
2943monitor-net X X X -
2944monitor-uri X X X -
2945option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2946option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2947option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2948option allbackups (*) X - X X
2949option checkcache (*) X - X X
2950option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2951option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02002952option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002953option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2954option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002955-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2956option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002957option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2958option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002959option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002960option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002961option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002962option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002963option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002964option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2965option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2966option httpchk X - X X
2967option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002968option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002969option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002970option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002971option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002972option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002973option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2974option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2975option logasap (*) X X X -
2976option mysql-check X - X X
2977option nolinger (*) X X X X
2978option originalto X X X X
2979option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002980option pgsql-check X - X X
2981option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002982option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002983option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002984option smtpchk X - X X
2985option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2986option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2987option splice-request (*) X X X X
2988option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002989option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002990option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2991option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2992-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002993option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002994option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2995option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2996option tcpka X X X X
2997option tcplog X X X X
2998option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002999external-check command X - X X
3000external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003001persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3002rate-limit sessions X X X -
3003redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003004-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003005retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003006retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003007server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003008server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003009server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003010source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003011srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3012srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3013srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003014stats admin - X X X
3015stats auth X X X X
3016stats enable X X X X
3017stats hide-version X X X X
3018stats http-request - X X X
3019stats realm X X X X
3020stats refresh X X X X
3021stats scope X X X X
3022stats show-desc X X X X
3023stats show-legends X X X X
3024stats show-node X X X X
3025stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003026-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3027stick match - - X X
3028stick on - - X X
3029stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003030stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003031stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003032tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003033tcp-check connect X - X X
3034tcp-check expect X - X X
3035tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003036tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003037tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003038tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003039tcp-check set-var X - X X
3040tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003041tcp-request connection - X X -
3042tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003043tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003044tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003045tcp-response content - - X X
3046tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003047timeout check X - X X
3048timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003049timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003050timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003051timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3052timeout http-request X X X X
3053timeout queue X - X X
3054timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003055timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003056timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003057timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003058transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003059unique-id-format X X X -
3060unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003061use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003062use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003063use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003064------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3065 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003066
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003067
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020030684.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3069---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003070
3071This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3072
3073
3074acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3075 Declare or complete an access list.
3076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3077 no | yes | yes | yes
3078 Example:
3079 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3080 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3081 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3082
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003083 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003084
3085
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003086backlog <conns>
3087 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3089 yes | yes | yes | no
3090 Arguments :
3091 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3092 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003093 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003094
3095 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3096 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3097 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3098 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3099 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3100 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3101 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3102 backlog parameter.
3103
3104 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3105 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3106 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3107
3108 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3109
3110
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003111balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003112balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003113 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3115 yes | no | yes | yes
3116 Arguments :
3117 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3118 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3119 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3120 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3121
3122 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3123 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3124 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3125 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003126 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003127 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003128 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3129 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3130 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3131 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3132 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3133 it, so that you don't worry.
3134
3135 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3136 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3137 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3138 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3139 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3140 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3141 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3142 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003143
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003144 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3145 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3146 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3147 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3148 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3149 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3150 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
3151 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
3152
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003153 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003154 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003155 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3156 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003157 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003158 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3159 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3160 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3161 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3162 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003163 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3164 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3165 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3166 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3167 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3168 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003169
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003170 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3171 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3172 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3173 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3174 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3175 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3176 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3177 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003178 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003179 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003180 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3181 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3182 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003183
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003184 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3185 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3186 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3187 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3188 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3189 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3190 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3191 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3192 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3193 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3194 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3195 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003196
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003197 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003198 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3199 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3200 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3201 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3202 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3203 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3204 URIs start with a leading "/".
3205
3206 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3207 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3208 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3209 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3210
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003211 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003212 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3213
3214 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003215 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3216 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003217 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3218 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3219 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3220 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003221 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003222 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3223 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003224
3225 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3226 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3227 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3228 server will receive the request.
3229
3230 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3231 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3232 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3233 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3234 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003235 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3236 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3237 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003238
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003239 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3240 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3241 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3242 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3243 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003244
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003245 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003246 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3247 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3248 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3249
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003250 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3251 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3252 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3253
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003254 random
3255 random(<draws>)
3256 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003257 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3258 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3259 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3260 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003261 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3262 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3263 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3264 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3265 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3266 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3267 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3268 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3269 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3270 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3271 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3272 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3273 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3274 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3275 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3276 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3277 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3278 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3279 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3280 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003281
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003282 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003283 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003284 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3285 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3286 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3287 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3288 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3289 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003290 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003291 used instead.
3292
3293 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3294 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3295 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3296 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3297
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003298 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3299 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3300 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3301
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003302 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003303
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003304 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003305 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3306 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003307
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003308 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3309 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3310 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003311
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003312 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003313 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003314 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3315 NTLM relies on.
3316
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003317 Examples :
3318 balance roundrobin
3319 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003320 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003321 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3322 balance hdr(host)
3323 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003324
3325 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3326 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3327
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003328 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003329 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3330 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3331 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003332 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003333
3334 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3335 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3336 defaults to 16 kB.
3337
3338 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3339 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3340
3341 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3342 Round Robin.
3343
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003344 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003345 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3346 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3347 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3348
3349 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3350
3351 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003352 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003353 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3354 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3355 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003356
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003357 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003358
3359
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003360bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3361bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003362 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3364 no | yes | yes | no
3365 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003366 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3367 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3368 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3369 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003370 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003371 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3372 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3373 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3374 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3375 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3376 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003377 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003378 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3379 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003380 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003381 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3382 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003383 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003384 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3385 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003386 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003387 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3388 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3389 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3390 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3391 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3392 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3393 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003394 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3395 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3396 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003397 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3398 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3399 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3400 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003401 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3402 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3403 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003404
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003405 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3406 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003407 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3408 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3409 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003410 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3411 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3412 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3413 the range.
3414
3415 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3416 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3417 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3418 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3419 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3420 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3421 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003422 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003423 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003424
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003425 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003426 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003427 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3428 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3429 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3430 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3431 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3432 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3433
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003434 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3435 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3436 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3437 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003438
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003439 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3440 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3441 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3442 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3443 in a frontend.
3444
3445 Example :
3446 listen http_proxy
3447 bind :80,:443
3448 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003449 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003450
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003451 listen http_https_proxy
3452 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003453 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003454
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003455 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3456 bind ipv6@:80
3457 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3458 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3459
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003460 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003461 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003462
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003463 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3464 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3465 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3466 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3467 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3468
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003469 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003470 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003471
3472
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003473bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003474 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3476 yes | yes | yes | yes
3477 Arguments :
3478 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3479 may be used to override a default value.
3480
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003481 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003482 option may be combined with other numbers.
3483
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003484 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003485 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3486 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3487 missing from all processes.
3488
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003489 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003490 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003491 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3492 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3493 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3494 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3495 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003496 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003497
3498 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3499 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3500 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3501 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3502 and 'even' instances.
3503
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003504 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3505 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3506 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3507 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003508
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003509 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3510 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3511
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003512 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3513 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3514 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3515
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003516 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3517 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3518
3519 Example :
3520 listen app_ip1
3521 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003522 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003523
3524 listen app_ip2
3525 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003526 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003527
3528 listen management
3529 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003530 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003531
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003532 listen management
3533 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3534 bind-process 1-4
3535
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003536 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003537
3538
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003539capture cookie <name> len <length>
3540 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3542 no | yes | yes | no
3543 Arguments :
3544 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3545 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3546 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3547 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003548 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003549
3550 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3551 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3552 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3553 right if it exceeds <length>.
3554
3555 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3556 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3557 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3558 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3559
3560 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3561 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3562 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3563
3564 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3565 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3566 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003567 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3568 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3569 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003570
3571 Example:
3572 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3573
3574 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003575 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003576
3577
3578capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003579 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3581 no | yes | yes | no
3582 Arguments :
3583 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003584 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003585 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3586 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3587 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3588
3589 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3590 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3591 it exceeds <length>.
3592
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003593 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003594 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3595 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003596 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3597 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3598 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3599 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003600 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003601 environments to find where the request came from.
3602
3603 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3604 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3605 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3606 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003607
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003608 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3609 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3610 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3611 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3612 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003613
3614 Example:
3615 capture request header Host len 15
3616 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003617 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003618
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003619 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003620 about logging.
3621
3622
3623capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003624 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3626 no | yes | yes | no
3627 Arguments :
3628 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003629 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003630 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3631 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3632 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3633
3634 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3635 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3636 it exceeds <length>.
3637
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003638 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003639 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3640 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3641 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003642 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3643 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3644 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3645 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003646
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003647 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3648 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3649 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3650 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3651 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003652
3653 Example:
3654 capture response header Content-length len 9
3655 capture response header Location len 15
3656
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003657 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003658 about logging.
3659
3660
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003661clitcpka-cnt <count>
3662 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
3663 the connection on the client side.
3664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3665 yes | yes | yes | no
3666 Arguments :
3667 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
3668
3669 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
3670 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003671 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3672 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003673
3674 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
3675
3676
3677clitcpka-idle <timeout>
3678 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
3679 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
3680 client side.
3681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3682 yes | yes | yes | no
3683 Arguments :
3684 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
3685 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
3686 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
3687 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
3688
3689 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
3690 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003691 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3692 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003693
3694 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
3695
3696
3697clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
3698 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
3699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3700 yes | yes | yes | no
3701 Arguments :
3702 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
3703 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
3704 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
3705 document.
3706
3707 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
3708 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003709 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3710 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003711
3712 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
3713
3714
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003715compression algo <algorithm> ...
3716compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003717compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003718 Enable HTTP compression.
3719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3720 yes | yes | yes | yes
3721 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003722 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3723 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3724 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3725
3726 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003727 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3728 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3729 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003730
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003731 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003732 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003733
3734 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3735 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3736 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3737 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3738 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003739 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003740
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003741 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3742 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3743 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3744 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3745 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3746 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3747 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003748 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003749
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003750 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003751 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003752 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3753 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3754 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3755 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3756 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003757
3758 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3759 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3760 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3761 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3762 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003763 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3764 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3765 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3766 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3767 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003768 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3769 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003770
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003771 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003772 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3773 "Accept-Encoding" header
3774 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003775 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003776 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3777 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3778 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3779 "multipart"
3780 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3781 header
3782 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3783 and later
3784 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3785 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003786 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003787
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003788 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003789
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003790 Examples :
3791 compression algo gzip
3792 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003793
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003794
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003795cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003796 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3797 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003798 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003799 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3801 yes | no | yes | yes
3802 Arguments :
3803 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3804 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3805 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3806 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3807 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3808 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003809 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003810 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3811 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3812
3813 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3814 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3815 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3816 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3817 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3818 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003819 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3820 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003821 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003822 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3823 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003824
3825 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003826 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003827
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003828 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003829 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003830 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003831 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003832 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3833 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3834 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3835 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3836 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3837 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3838 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003839
3840 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3841 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3842 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3843 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3844 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3845 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3846 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3847 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3848 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003849 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003850 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3851 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3852 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003853
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003854 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3855 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3856 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003857 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3858 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3859 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3860 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003861 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3862 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3863 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003864
3865 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3866 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3867 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3868 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3869 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3870 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3871 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3872 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3873 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3874
3875 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3876 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3877 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3878 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3879 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3880 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3881 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3882 persistence cookie in the cache.
3883 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3884
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003885 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3886 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3887 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3888 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3889 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003890 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003891 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3892 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3893 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3894 they logout.
3895
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003896 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3897 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3898 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3899 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3900
3901 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3902 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3903 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3904 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3905 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3906 this attribute.
3907
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003908 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003909 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003910 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3911 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3912 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3913 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3914 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3915 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003916
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003917 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3918 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3919 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3920 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3921 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3922 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3923 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3924 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003925 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003926 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3927 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3928 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3929 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3930 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3931 the site.
3932
3933 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3934 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3935 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3936 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3937 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3938 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3939 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3940 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3941 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3942 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3943 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3944 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3945 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003946 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003947 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3948 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3949
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003950 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3951 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3952 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3953 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3954 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3955 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3956
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003957 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3958 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3959 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3960 repeated.
3961
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003962 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3963 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3964 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3965 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003966
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003967 Examples :
3968 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3969 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3970 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003971 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003972
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003973 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003974
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003975
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003976declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3977 Declares a capture slot.
3978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3979 no | yes | yes | no
3980 Arguments:
3981 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3982
3983 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3984 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3985 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3986 for use in the response.
3987
3988 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003989 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003990 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3991
3992
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003993default-server [param*]
3994 Change default options for a server in a backend
3995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3996 yes | no | yes | yes
3997 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003998 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3999 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4000 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4001 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004002
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004003 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004004 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4005
4006 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004007
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004008
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004009default_backend <backend>
4010 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4012 yes | yes | yes | no
4013 Arguments :
4014 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4015
4016 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4017 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4018 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4019 will catch all undetermined requests.
4020
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004021 Example :
4022
4023 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4024 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4025 default_backend dynamic
4026
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004027 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004028
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004029
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004030description <string>
4031 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4033 no | yes | yes | yes
4034 Arguments : string
4035
4036 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4037 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4038 it describes.
4039 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4040
4041
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004042disabled
4043 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4045 yes | yes | yes | yes
4046 Arguments : none
4047
4048 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4049 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4050 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4051 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4052 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4053 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4054 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4055
4056 See also : "enabled"
4057
4058
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004059dispatch <address>:<port>
4060 Set a default server address
4061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4062 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004063 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004064
4065 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4066 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4067 during start-up.
4068
4069 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4070 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4071 possible with normal servers.
4072
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004073 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004074 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4075 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4076 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4077 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4078
4079 See also : "server"
4080
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004081
4082dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4083 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4085 yes | no | yes | yes
4086 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4087
4088 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004089 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004090 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4091 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004092 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004093 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004094
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004095enabled
4096 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4098 yes | yes | yes | yes
4099 Arguments : none
4100
4101 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4102 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4103
4104 See also : "disabled"
4105
4106
4107errorfile <code> <file>
4108 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4110 yes | yes | yes | yes
4111 Arguments :
4112 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004113 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004114 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004115
4116 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004117 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004118 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004119 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4120 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004121
4122 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4123 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4124 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4125
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004126 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4127
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004128 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4129 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4130 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4131 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4132 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4133 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4134 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4135 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4136 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004137
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004138 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4139 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4140 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004141 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004142 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4143
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004144 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004145
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004146 Example :
4147 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004148 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004149 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4150 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4151
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004152
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004153errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4154 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4155 section.
4156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4157 yes | yes | yes | yes
4158 Arguments :
4159 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4160
4161 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004162 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004163 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004164
4165 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4166 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4167 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4168 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4169 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004170 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004171 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4172
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004173 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4174 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004175
4176 Example :
4177 errorfiles generic
4178 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4179
4180
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004181errorloc <code> <url>
4182errorloc302 <code> <url>
4183 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4185 yes | yes | yes | yes
4186 Arguments :
4187 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004188 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004189 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004190
4191 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4192 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4193 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4194 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004195 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004196
4197 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4198 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4199 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4200
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004201 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4202
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004203 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4204 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4205 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4206 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004207 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004208 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4209 request.
4210
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004211 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004212
4213
4214errorloc303 <code> <url>
4215 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4217 yes | yes | yes | yes
4218 Arguments :
4219 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004220 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004221 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004222
4223 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4224 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4225 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4226 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004227 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004228
4229 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4230 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4231 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4232
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004233 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4234
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004235 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4236 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4237 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4238 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004239 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004240
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004241 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004242
4243
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004244email-alert from <emailaddr>
4245 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004246 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004247 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4248 yes | yes | yes | yes
4249
4250 Arguments :
4251
4252 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4253
4254 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4255 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4256
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004257 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004258 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4259 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004260
4261
4262email-alert level <level>
4263 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4264 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4265 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4266 yes | yes | yes | yes
4267
4268 Arguments :
4269
4270 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4271 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4272 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4273
4274 By default level is alert
4275
4276 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4277 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4278 for the proxy.
4279
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004280 Alerts are sent when :
4281
4282 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4283 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4284 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4285 is notice or lower
4286 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4287 and a health check status update occurs
4288
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004289 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4290 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004291 section 3.6 about mailers.
4292
4293
4294email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4295 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4296 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4297 yes | yes | yes | yes
4298
4299 Arguments :
4300
4301 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4302
4303 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4304 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4305
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004306 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4307 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004308
4309
4310email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4311 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4312 mailers.
4313 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4314 yes | yes | yes | yes
4315
4316 Arguments :
4317
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004318 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004319
4320 By default the systems hostname is used.
4321
4322 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4323 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4324 for the proxy.
4325
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004326 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4327 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004328
4329
4330email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004331 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004332 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4333 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4334 yes | yes | yes | yes
4335
4336 Arguments :
4337
4338 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4339
4340 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4341 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4342
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004343 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004344 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4345
4346
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004347force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4348 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4349 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004350 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004351
4352 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4353 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4354 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4355 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4356 marked down for maintenance operations.
4357
4358 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4359 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4360 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4361 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4362 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4363 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4364 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4365 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4366 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4367
4368 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4369 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4370 is used.
4371
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004372 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004373 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004374
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004375
4376filter <name> [param*]
4377 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4379 no | yes | yes | yes
4380 Arguments :
4381 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4382 referenced in section 9.
4383
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004384 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004385 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004386 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4387 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004388
4389 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4390 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4391
4392 Example:
4393 listen
4394 bind *:80
4395
4396 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4397 filter compression
4398 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4399
4400 compression algo gzip
4401 compression offload
4402
4403 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4404
4405 See also : section 9.
4406
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004407
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004408fullconn <conns>
4409 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4411 yes | no | yes | yes
4412 Arguments :
4413 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4414 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4415
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004416 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004417 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004418 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004419 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4420 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4421 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4422 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4423 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004424 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004425
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004426 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4427 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004428 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4429 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4430 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004431
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004432 Example :
4433 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4434 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4435 # connections.
4436 backend dynamic
4437 fullconn 10000
4438 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4439 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4440
4441 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4442
4443
4444grace <time>
4445 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004447 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004448 Arguments :
4449 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4450 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4451 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4452
4453 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4454 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004455 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004456 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4457
4458 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4459 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4460 simplify it.
4461
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004462
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004463hash-balance-factor <factor>
4464 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4466 yes | no | no | yes
4467 Arguments :
4468 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4469 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004470 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004471
4472 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4473 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4474 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4475 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4476 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4477 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4478 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4479
4480 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4481 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4482 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4483 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4484 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4485
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004486 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4487 consistent hashing mechanism.
4488
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004489 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4490
4491
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004492hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004493 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4495 yes | no | yes | yes
4496 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004497 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4498 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004499
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004500 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4501 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4502 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4503 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4504 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4505 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4506 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4507 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4508 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4509 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004510
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004511 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4512 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4513 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4514 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4515 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4516 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4517 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4518 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4519 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4520 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4521 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4522 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4523 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004524 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4525 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004526
4527 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4528
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004529 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004530 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4531 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4532 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004533 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4534 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4535 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004536
4537 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4538 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004539 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4540 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4541 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4542 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4543
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004544 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4545 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4546 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4547 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4548 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4549 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4550 parameter.
4551
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004552 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4553 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4554 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4555 used on strings.
4556
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004557 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4558
4559 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4560 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4561 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4562 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4563 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4564 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4565 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4566 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4567 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4568 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4569 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4570 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004571
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004572 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4573 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4574 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004575
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004576 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004577
4578
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004579http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4580 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4581 ones).
4582
4583 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4584 no | yes | yes | yes
4585
4586 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4587 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4588 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4589 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4590 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4591 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4592
4593 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4594 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4595 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4596
4597 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4598 below.
4599
4600 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4601 instance.
4602
4603 Example:
4604 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4605 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4606 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4607
4608http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4609
4610 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4611 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4612 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4613 example, or to pass some internal information.
4614 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4615 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4616 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4617
4618http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4619
4620 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4621 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4622
4623http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4624
4625 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4626
4627http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4628 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4629
4630 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4631
4632 Example:
4633 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4634
4635 # applied to:
4636 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4637
4638 # outputs:
4639 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4640
4641 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4642
4643http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4644 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4645
4646 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4647
4648 Example:
4649 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4650
4651 # applied to:
4652 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4653
4654 # outputs:
4655 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4656
4657http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4658
4659 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4660 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4661 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4662
4663http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4664 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4665
4666 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4667 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4668 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4669 fallback.
4670
4671 Example:
4672 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4673 http-response set-status 431
4674 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4675 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4676
4677http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4678
4679 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4680 inline.
4681
4682 Arguments:
4683 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4684 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4685 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4686 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4687 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4688 (request and response)
4689 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4690 processing
4691 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4692 processing
4693 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4694 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4695 and '_'.
4696
4697 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4698 followed by some converters.
4699
4700 Example:
4701 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4702
4703http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4704
4705 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4706 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4707 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4708 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4709 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004710 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004711 processing.
4712
4713 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4714 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004715 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004716 rules evaluation.
4717
4718http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4719
4720 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4721 details about <var-name>.
4722
4723 Example:
4724 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4725
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004726
4727http-check comment <string>
4728 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
4729 it fails.
4730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4731 yes | no | yes | yes
4732
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004733 Arguments :
4734 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
4735 rule fails.
4736
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004737 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
4738 user-friendly error reporting.
4739
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004740 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004741 "http-check expect".
4742
4743
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004744http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
4745 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004746 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004747 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
4748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4749 yes | no | yes | yes
4750
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004751 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004752 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4753
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004754 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004755 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004756
4757 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
4758 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
4759 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
4760 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
4761
4762 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
4763
4764 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
4765
4766 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
4767
4768 ssl opens a ciphered connection
4769
4770 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
4771
4772 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
4773 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
4774 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
4775 is used.
4776
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004777 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
4778 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
4779 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
4780 haproxy -vv.
4781
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004782 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
4783
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004784 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
4785 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
4786 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
4787 different ports or with different servers.
4788
4789 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
4790 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
4791 the port with a "http-check connect".
4792
4793 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
4794 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
4795 do.
4796
4797 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
4798 unset-var or comment rules.
4799
4800 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004801 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
4802 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
4803 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
4804 option httpchk
4805
4806 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004807 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004808 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004809 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004810 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004811 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004812
4813 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
4814
4815 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004816
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004817
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004818http-check disable-on-404
4819 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004821 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004822 Arguments : none
4823
4824 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4825 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4826 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4827 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4828 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4829 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4830 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4831 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004832 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4833 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4834 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4835
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004836 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004837
4838
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004839http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004840 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
4841 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
4842 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004843 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004845 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004846
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004847 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004848 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4849
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004850 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
4851 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
4852 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
4853 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
4854 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
4855 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
4856 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
4857 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
4858 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
4859 result is always conclusive.
4860
4861 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4862 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
4863 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004864 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
4865 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
4866 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
4867 example 404 with disable-on-404
4868 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
4869 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
4870 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004871
4872 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4873 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004874 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
4875 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
4876 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
4877 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
4878 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
4879 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004880
4881 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4882 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004883 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
4884 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
4885 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
4886 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004887 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
4888
4889 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4890 informational message reported in logs if the expect
4891 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
4892 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
4893
4894 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4895 informational message reported in logs if an error
4896 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
4897 log-format string.
4898
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004899 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004900 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
4901 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004902 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4903 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4904 details on the supported keywords.
4905
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004906 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
4907 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
4908 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
4909 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004910
4911 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4912 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4913 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4914 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4915 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4916
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004917 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
4918 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
4919 codes. A health check response will be considered as
4920 valid if the response's status code matches any status
4921 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
4922 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4923 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004924
4925 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004926 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004927 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4928 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4929 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4930 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4931
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004932 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4933 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004934 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
4935 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
4936 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
4937 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
4938 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
4939 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
4940 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
4941 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004942 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
4943 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
4944 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
4945 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
4946 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
4947 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
4948 insensitive on the header names.
4949
4950 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4951 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
4952 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
4953 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
4954 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
4955 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004956
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004957 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004958 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004959 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4960 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4961 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4962 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4963 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004964 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004965 trace).
4966
4967 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004968 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004969 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4970 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4971 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4972 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4973 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004974 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004975
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02004976 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
4977 A health check response will be considered valid if the
4978 response's body contains the string resulting of the
4979 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
4980 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4981 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
4982
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004983 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4984 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4985 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4986 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4987 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4988 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4989 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4990 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4991
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004992 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
4993 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
4994 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
4995 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
4996 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004997
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004998 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4999 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5000
5001 Examples :
5002 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005003 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005004
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005005 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5006 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5007
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005008 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005009 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005010
5011 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005012 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005013
5014 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005015 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005016
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005017 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005018 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005019
5020
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005021http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005022 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5023 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005024 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5025 health checks.
5026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5027 yes | no | yes | yes
5028 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005029 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5030
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005031 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5032 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5033 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5034 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5035 to invent non-standard ones.
5036
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005037 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5038 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5039 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5040 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5041
5042 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5043 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5044 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5045 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005046
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005047 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005048 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005049 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005050 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5051 to add it.
5052
5053 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5054 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5055 to the log-format rules.
5056
5057 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5058 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5059 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005060
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005061 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5062 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5063 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5064 request.
5065
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005066 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5067 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5068 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005069 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5070 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5071 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5072 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005073 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005074 "http-check expect" directive is defined independently of this directive, just
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005075 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
5076
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005077 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
5078 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005079 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
5080 so, it will be ignored.
5081
5082 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5083 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5084 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5085 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5086 configured request authority.
5087
5088 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5089 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005090
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005091 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005092
5093
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005094http-check send-state
5095 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5097 yes | no | yes | yes
5098 Arguments : none
5099
5100 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5101 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5102 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5103 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5104 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5105
5106 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5107 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5108 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5109 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5110 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005111 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5112 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5113 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5114
5115 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5116 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5117 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5118
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005119 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5120 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5121 checked in multiple backends.
5122
5123 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5124 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5125
5126 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5127 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5128 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5129 one fails.
5130
5131 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5132 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5133 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5134
5135 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5136 server's queue.
5137
5138 Example of a header received by the application server :
5139 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5140 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5141
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005142 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5143 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005144
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005145
5146http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005147 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005148 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5149 yes | no | yes | yes
5150
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005151 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005152 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5153 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5154 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5155 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5156 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5157 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5158 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5159 and '-'.
5160
5161 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5162
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005163 Examples :
5164 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005165
5166
5167http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005168 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005169 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5170 yes | no | yes | yes
5171
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005172 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005173 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5174 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5175 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5176 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5177 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5178 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5179 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5180 and '-'.
5181
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005182 Examples :
5183 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005184
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005185
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005186http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5187 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5188 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5189 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5190 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5192 yes | yes | yes | yes
5193 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005194 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005195 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005196 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
5197 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005198
5199 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5200 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5201 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5202 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5203
5204 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5205 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5206 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5207 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5208
5209 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5210 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5211 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5212 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5213 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5214 chroot is performed.
5215
5216 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5217 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5218 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5219 considered.
5220
5221 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5222 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5223 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5224 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5225 considered as a raw string.
5226
5227 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5228 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5229 "content-type".
5230
5231 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5232 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5233 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5234 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5235 evaluated as a log-format string.
5236
5237 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5238 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5239 argument to "content-type".
5240
5241 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5242 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5243 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5244 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5245
5246 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5247 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5248 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5249 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5250 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5251 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5252 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5253 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5254
5255 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5256 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5257 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5258
5259 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5260 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5261
5262
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005263http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005264 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5265
5266 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5267 no | yes | yes | yes
5268
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005269 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5270 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5271 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5272 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5273 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005274
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005275 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5276 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005277
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005278 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005279
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005280 Example:
5281 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5282 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5283 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005284
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005285 http-request allow if nagios
5286 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5287 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5288 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005289
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005290 Example:
5291 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5292 acl add path /addacl
5293 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005294
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005295 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005296
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005297 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5298 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005299
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005300 Example:
5301 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5302 acl setmap path /setmap
5303 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005304
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005305 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005306
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005307 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5308 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005309
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005310 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5311 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005312
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005313http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005314
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005315 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5316 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5317 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5318 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5319 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5320 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5321 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5322 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005323
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005324http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005325
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005326 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5327 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5328 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5329 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5330 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5331 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5332 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5333 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005334
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005335http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005336
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005337 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5338 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005339
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005340
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005341http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005342
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005343 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5344 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5345 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5346 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5347 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005348
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005349 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5350 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5351 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5352 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5353 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5354 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5355 instead.
5356
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005357 Example:
5358 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5359 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005360
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005361http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005362
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005363 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005364
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005365http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5366 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005367
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005368 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5369 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5370 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5371 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5372 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5373 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5374 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5375 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5376 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005377
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005378 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5379 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5380 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005381 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5382
5383 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5384 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5385 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5386 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005387
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005388http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005389
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005390 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5391 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5392 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5393 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5394 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5395 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005396
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005397http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005398
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005399 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005400
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005401http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005402
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005403 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5404 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5405 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5406 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5407 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5408 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005409
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005410http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5411http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5412 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5413 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5414 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5415 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005416
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005417 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5418 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5419 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005420 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005421 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5422 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5423 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005424 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005425 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005426
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005427http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5428 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5429 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5430 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5431
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005432http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5433
5434 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5435 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5436 pointed by <resolvers>.
5437 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5438 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5439 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5440 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5441 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5442 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5443 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5444 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5445 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5446 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5447 to 0.0.0.0.
5448
5449 Example:
5450 resolvers mydns
5451 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5452 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5453 timeout retry 1s
5454 hold valid 10s
5455 hold nx 3s
5456 hold other 3s
5457 hold obsolete 0s
5458 accepted_payload_size 8192
5459
5460 frontend fe
5461 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5462 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5463 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5464
5465 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5466 # which mean DNS resolution error
5467 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5468
5469 default_backend be
5470
5471 backend b_503
5472 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5473 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5474 # 503 error page to end users
5475
5476 backend be
5477 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5478 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5479 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5480 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5481 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5482
5483 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5484 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5485
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005486http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5487
5488 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5489 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5490 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5491 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005492 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5493 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005494
5495 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5496
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005497http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005498
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005499 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5500 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5501 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5502 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5503 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005504
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005505http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005506
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005507 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5508 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5509 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5510 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005511
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005512http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5513 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005514
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005515 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005516 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5517 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5518 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5519 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5520 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005521
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005522 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5523 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5524 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5525 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5526 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005527
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005528 Example:
5529 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5530
5531 # applied to:
5532 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5533
5534 # outputs:
5535 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5536
5537 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005538
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005539 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5540
5541 # applied to:
5542 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005543
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005544 # outputs:
5545 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005546
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005547http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5548 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5549
5550 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5551 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02005552 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
5553 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
5554 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005555
5556 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5557 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5558 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5559
5560 Example:
5561 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5562 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5563
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005564 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5565 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5566 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5567 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5568
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005569http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5570 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5571
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005572 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5573 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5574 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5575 against.
5576
5577 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5578 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5579 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005580
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005581 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5582 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5583 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5584 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5585 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5586 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5587 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5588 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5589 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005590 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5591 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005592
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005593 Example:
5594 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5595 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005596
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005597 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5598 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005599
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005600http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5601 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005602
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005603 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5604 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5605 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5606 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005607
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005608 Example:
5609 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005610
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005611 # applied to:
5612 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005613
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005614 # outputs:
5615 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005616
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005617http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5618 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5619 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005620 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005621 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5622
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005623 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005624 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5625 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005626 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005627 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005628 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005629 are followed to create the response :
5630
5631 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5632 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5633 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5634 ignored.
5635
5636 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5637 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005638 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005639 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
5640 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005641
5642 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5643 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5644 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005645 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005646 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005647
5648 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5649 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5650 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005651 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005652 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
5653 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005654
5655 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5656 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5657 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5658 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5659 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5660 as a raw content.
5661
5662 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5663 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5664 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5665 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5666 considered as a raw string.
5667
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005668 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5669 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5670 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5671 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5672
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005673 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5674 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005675 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005676
5677 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5678
5679 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005680 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005681 if { path /ping }
5682
5683 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
5684 if { path /favicon.ico }
5685
5686 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
5687 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
5688 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
5689
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005690http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5691http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005692
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005693 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5694 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5695 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005696
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005697http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5698 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005699
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005700 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5701 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5702 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5703 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005704
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005705http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005706
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005707 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5708 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5709 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5710 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5711 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005712
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005713 Arguments:
5714 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5715 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005716
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005717 Example:
5718 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5719 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005720
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005721 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5722 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005723
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005724http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005725
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005726 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5727 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5728 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005729
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005730 Arguments:
5731 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5732 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005733
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005734 Example:
5735 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5736 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005737
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005738 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5739 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5740 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005741
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005742http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005743
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005744 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5745 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5746 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5747 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5748 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005749
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005750 Example:
5751 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5752 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5753 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5754 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5755 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5756 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5757 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5758 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5759 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005760
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005761http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005762
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005763 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5764 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5765 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5766 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5767 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005768
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005769http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5770 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005771
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005772 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5773 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5774 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5775 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5776 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5777 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5778 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5779 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5780 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005781
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005782http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005783
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005784 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5785 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5786 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5787 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5788 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5789 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5790 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005791
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005792http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005793
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005794 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5795 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5796 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005797
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005798http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005799
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005800 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5801 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5802 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5803 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5804 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5805 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5806 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5807 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005808
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005809http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005810
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005811 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5812 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5813 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5814 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5815 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5816 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005817
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005818 Example :
5819 # prepend the host name before the path
5820 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005821
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005822http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005823
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005824 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5825 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5826 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5827 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5828 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005829
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005830http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005831
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005832 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5833 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5834 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5835 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5836 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5837 values have higher priority.
5838 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5839 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5840 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5841 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5842 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005843
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005844http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005845
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005846 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5847 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5848 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5849 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5850 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5851 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5852 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005853
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005854 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005855
5856 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005857 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5858 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005859
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005860http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5861 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5862 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5863 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005864 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5865 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005866
5867 Arguments :
5868 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5869 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005870
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005871 See also "option forwardfor".
5872
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005873 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005874 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5875 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5876
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005877 # After the masking this will track connections
5878 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5879 http-request track-sc0 src
5880
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005881 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5882 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5883
5884http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5885
5886 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5887 expression.
5888
5889 Arguments:
5890 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5891 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005892
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005893 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005894 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5895 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5896
5897 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5898 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5899 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5900
5901http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5902
5903 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5904 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5905 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5906 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5907 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5908 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5909 information from the request.
5910
5911 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5912
5913http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5914
5915 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5916 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5917 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5918 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5919 path and the query string.
5920 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5921
5922http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5923
5924 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5925 inline.
5926
5927 Arguments:
5928 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5929 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5930 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5931 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5932 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5933 (request and response)
5934 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5935 processing
5936 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5937 processing
5938 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5939 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5940 and '_'.
5941
5942 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5943 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005944
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005945 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005946 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005947
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005948http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5949 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005950
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005951 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5952 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5953 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5954 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5955 agent name must be used.
5956
5957 Arguments:
5958 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5959
5960 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5961 configuration.
5962
5963http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5964
5965 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5966 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5967 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5968 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5969 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5970 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5971 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5972 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5973 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5974 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5975 action.
5976 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5977 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5978 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5979 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5980 you fully understand how it works.
5981
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005982http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5983
5984 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5985 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5986 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5987 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5988 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005989 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005990 processing.
5991
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005992 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005993 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5994 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5995 rules evaluation.
5996
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005997http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5998http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5999 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6000 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6001 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6002 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006003
6004 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6005 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6006 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006007 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6008 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6009 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6010 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6011 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6012 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6013 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6014 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6015 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6016 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006017 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006018 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6019 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6020 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6021 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6022 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006023
6024http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6025http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6026http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6027
6028 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6029 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6030 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6031 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
6032 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
6033 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6034 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6035 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6036 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6037 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6038 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6039 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6040
6041 Arguments :
6042 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6043 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6044 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6045 select which table entry to update the counters.
6046
6047 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6048 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6049 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6050 that table until the session ends.
6051
6052 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6053 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6054 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6055 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6056 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6057 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6058 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6059 useful information.
6060
6061 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6062 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6063 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6064 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6065 checks that make use of it.
6066
6067http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6068
6069 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006070
6071 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006072 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006073
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006074http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6075
6076 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6077 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6078 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6079 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6080 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6081 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6082
6083 Arguments :
6084 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6085
6086 Example:
6087 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6088
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006089http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006090
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006091 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6092 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6093 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006094
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006095
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006096http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006097 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6098
6099 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6100 no | yes | yes | yes
6101
6102 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6103 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6104 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6105 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6106 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6107 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6108
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006109 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6110 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006111
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006112 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006113
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006114 Example:
6115 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006116
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006117 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006118
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006119 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6120 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006121
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006122 Example:
6123 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006124
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006125 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006126
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006127 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6128 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006129
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006130 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6131 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006132
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006133http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006134
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006135 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6136 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6137 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6138 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6139 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6140 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6141 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6142 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006143
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006144http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006145
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006146 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6147 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6148 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6149 example, or to pass some internal information.
6150 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6151 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6152 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006153
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006154http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006155
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006156 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6157 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006158
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006159http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006160
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006161 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006162
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006163http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006164
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006165 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6166 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6167 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6168 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6169 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6170 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6171 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006172
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006173 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6174 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6175 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6176 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6177 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006178
6179 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6180 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6181 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6182 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006183
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006184http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006185
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006186 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6187 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6188 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6189 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6190 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6191 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006192
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006193http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006194
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006195 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006196
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006197http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006198
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006199 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6200 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6201 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6202 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6203 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6204 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006205
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006206http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6207http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6208 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6209 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6210 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6211 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006212
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006213 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6214 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6215 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006216 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006217 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6218 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6219 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006220 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006221 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006222
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006223http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006224
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006225 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6226 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6227 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6228 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6229 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6230 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006231
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006232http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6233 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006234
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006235 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6236 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006237
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006238 Example:
6239 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006240
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006241 # applied to:
6242 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006243
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006244 # outputs:
6245 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006246
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006247 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006248
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006249http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6250 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006251
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006252 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006253 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006254
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006255 Example:
6256 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006257
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006258 # applied to:
6259 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006260
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006261 # outputs:
6262 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006263
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006264http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6265 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6266 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006267 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006268 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6269
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006270 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006271 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6272 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006273 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006274 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006275 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006276 are followed to create the response :
6277
6278 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6279 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6280 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6281 ignored.
6282
6283 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6284 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006285 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006286 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
6287 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006288
6289 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6290 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6291 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006292 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006293 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006294
6295 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6296 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6297 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006298 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006299 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6300 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006301
6302 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6303 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6304 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6305 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6306 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6307 as a raw content.
6308
6309 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6310 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6311 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6312 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6313 considered as a raw string.
6314
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006315 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6316 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6317 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6318 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6319
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006320 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6321 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006322 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006323
6324 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6325
6326 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006327 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006328 if { status eq 404 }
6329
6330 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6331 string "This is the end !" \
6332 if { status eq 500 }
6333
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006334http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6335http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006336
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006337 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6338 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6339 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006340
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006341http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6342 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006343
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006344 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6345 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6346 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6347 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006348
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006349http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006350
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006351 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6352 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6353 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6354 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6355 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006356
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006357 Arguments:
6358 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006359
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006360 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6361 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006362
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006363http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006364
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006365 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6366 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6367 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006368
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006369http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6370
6371 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6372 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6373 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6374 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6375 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6376
6377http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6378
6379 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6380 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6381 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6382 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6383 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6384 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6385 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6386 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6387 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6388
6389http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6390
6391 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6392 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6393 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6394 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6395 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6396 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6397 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6398
6399http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6400
6401 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6402 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6403 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6404 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6405 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6406 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6407 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6408 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6409
6410http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6411 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6412
6413 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6414 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6415 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6416 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006417
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006418 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006419 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6420 http-response set-status 431
6421 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6422 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006423
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006424http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006425
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006426 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6427 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6428 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6429 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6430 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6431 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6432 based on some information from the request.
6433
6434 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6435
6436http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6437
6438 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6439 inline.
6440
6441 Arguments:
6442 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6443 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6444 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6445 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6446 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6447 (request and response)
6448 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6449 processing
6450 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6451 processing
6452 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6453 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6454 and '_'.
6455
6456 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6457 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006458
6459 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006460 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006461
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006462http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006463
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006464 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6465 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6466 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6467 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6468 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6469 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6470 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6471 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6472 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6473 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6474 action.
6475 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6476 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6477 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6478 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6479 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006480
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006481http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6482
6483 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6484 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6485 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6486 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6487 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006488 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006489 processing.
6490
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006491 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006492 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006493 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006494 rules evaluation.
6495
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006496http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6497http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6498http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006499
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006500 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6501 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6502 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6503 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6504 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6505 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6506
6507http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6508
6509 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6510 about <var-name>.
6511
6512 Example:
6513 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6514
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006515
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006516http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6517 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6518
6519 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6520 yes | no | yes | yes
6521
6522 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006523 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6524 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6525 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006526
6527 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6528
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006529 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6530 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6531 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6532 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6533 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6534 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6535 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6536 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6537 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6538 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006539
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006540 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6541 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6542 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6543 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6544 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6545 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6546 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
6547 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006548
6549 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6550 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6551 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6552 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6553 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6554 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6555 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6556 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006557 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006558 downsides of rare connection failures.
6559
6560 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6561 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6562 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6563 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6564 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6565 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006566 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006567 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6568 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6569 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6570 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6571 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6572
6573 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006574 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6575 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6576 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006577
6578 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006579 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006580
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006581 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6582 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006583
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006584 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006585
6586 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6587 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6588 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6589
6590 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6591
6592
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006593http-send-name-header [<header>]
6594 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006595 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6596 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006597 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006598 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6599
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006600 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6601 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6602 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6603 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6604 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6605 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6606 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6607 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6608 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6609 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6610 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6611 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6612 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6613 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6614 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6615 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006616
6617 See also : "server"
6618
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006619id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006620 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6622 no | yes | yes | yes
6623 Arguments : none
6624
6625 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6626 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6627 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006628
6629
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006630ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6631 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6632 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006633 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006634
6635 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6636 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6637 and running).
6638
6639 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6640 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6641 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006642 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006643 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6644
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006645 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6646 "unless" condition is met.
6647
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006648 Example:
6649 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6650 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6651 ignore-persist if url_static
6652
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006653 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6654
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006655load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6656 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6657 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6658 yes | no | yes | yes
6659
6660 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6661 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6662 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006663 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006664 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6665 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6666 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6667 over the stats socket and redirect output.
6668
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006669 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006670 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02006671 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006672
6673 Arguments:
6674 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
6675 named "server-state-file".
6676
6677 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
6678 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
6679 name is used as a file name.
6680
6681 none don't load any stat for this backend
6682
6683 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006684 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
6685 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
6686 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006687 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006688 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006689
6690 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
6691 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
6692
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006693 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006694
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006695 global
6696 stats socket /tmp/socket
6697 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006698
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006699 defaults
6700 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006701
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006702 backend bk
6703 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6704 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006705
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006706
6707 Then one can run :
6708
6709 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6710
6711 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6712
6713 1
6714 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6715 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6716 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6717
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006718 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006719
6720 global
6721 stats socket /tmp/socket
6722 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6723
6724 defaults
6725 load-server-state-from-file local
6726
6727 backend bk
6728 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6729 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6730
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006731
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006732 Then one can run :
6733
6734 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6735
6736 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6737
6738 1
6739 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6740 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6741 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6742
6743 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6744 "show servers state"
6745
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006746
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006747log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006748log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6749 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006750no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006751 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6753 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006754
6755 Prefix :
6756 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6757 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6758 prefix does not allow arguments.
6759
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006760 Arguments :
6761 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6762 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6763 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6764 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6765 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6766 parameter.
6767
6768 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6769 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6770
6771 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6772 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6773 standard syslog port).
6774
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006775 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6776 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6777 standard syslog port).
6778
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006779 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6780 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6781 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006782 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006783
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006784 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6785 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6786 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6787 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6788 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6789 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6790 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6791 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6792 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6793 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6794 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6795 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6796 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6797 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6798 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6799 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006800 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6801 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006802
6803 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6804 and "fd@2", see above.
6805
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006806 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6807 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6808 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6809 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6810 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6811 having the logs instantly available.
6812
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006813 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6814 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006815
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006816 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6817 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6818 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6819 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6820 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6821 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6822 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6823 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6824 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6825 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006826 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006827
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006828 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6829 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6830 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6831 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6832 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6833
6834 <sample_size>
6835 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6836 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6837 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6838 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6839 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6840
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006841 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6842 one of the following :
6843
6844 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6845 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6846
6847 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6848 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6849
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02006850 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
6851 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
6852 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
6853 designed to be used with a local log server.
6854
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006855 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6856 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6857 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6858 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6859 systemd logger consumes.
6860
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02006861 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6862 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
6863 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
6864 used with a local log server.
6865
6866 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
6867 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
6868 designed to be used with a local log server.
6869
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006870 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6871 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6872 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6873 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6874
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006875 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6876
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006877 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6878 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6879 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6880
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006881 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6882 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6883 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6884 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006885
6886 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6887 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6888 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006889 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6890 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6891 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6892 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6893 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006894
6895 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6896
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006897 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6898 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6899 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006900
6901 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6902 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6903 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6904 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6905
6906 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6907 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006908
6909 Example :
6910 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006911 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6912 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6913 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006914 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6915 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006916 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006917
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006918
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006919log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006920 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6921 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6922 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006923
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006924 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6925 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6926 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6927 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6928 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006929
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006930 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6931 "option httplog" directives.
6932
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006933log-format-sd <string>
6934 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6935 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6936 yes | yes | yes | no
6937
6938 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6939 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6940 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6941 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6942 which covers the log format string in depth.
6943
6944 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6945 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6946
6947 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6948 log format to "rfc5424".
6949
6950 Example :
6951 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6952
6953
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006954log-tag <string>
6955 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6956 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6957 yes | yes | yes | yes
6958
6959 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6960 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6961 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6962 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6963 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6964 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6965 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6966 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6967 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006968
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006969max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6970 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6971 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6972 yes | no | yes | yes
6973
6974 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6975 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6976 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6977 servers.
6978
6979 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6980 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6981 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6982 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6983 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006984 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006985 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6986 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6987 picking a different server.
6988
6989 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6990 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6991 even if they have to be queued.
6992
6993 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6994 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6995
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006996max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6997 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6998 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6999 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007000
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007001maxconn <conns>
7002 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7004 yes | yes | yes | no
7005 Arguments :
7006 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7007 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7008 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7009 closes.
7010
7011 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7012 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7013 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7014 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007015 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7016 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7017 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7018 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007019
7020 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7021 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7022 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7023
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007024 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7025 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007026
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007027 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7028
7029
7030mode { tcp|http|health }
7031 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7033 yes | yes | yes | yes
7034 Arguments :
7035 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7036 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7037 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7038 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7039
7040 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7041 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7042 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7043 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7044 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7045
7046 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02007047 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
7048 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
7049 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
7050 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
7051 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
7052 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
7053 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007054
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007055 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7056 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7057 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007058
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007059 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007060 defaults http_instances
7061 mode http
7062
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007063 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007064
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007065
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007066monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007067 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7069 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007070 Arguments :
7071 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7072 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007073 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007074 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7075 backend and its backup.
7076
7077 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7078 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7079 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7080 servers in a list of backends.
7081
7082 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7083 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7084 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7085 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7086 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7087 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7088 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007089 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7090 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007091
7092 Example:
7093 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007094 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007095 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7096 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7097 monitor-uri /site_alive
7098 monitor fail if site_dead
7099
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007100 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007101
7102
7103monitor-net <source>
7104 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
7105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7106 yes | yes | yes | no
7107 Arguments :
7108 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
7109 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
7110 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
7111 followed by a mask.
7112
7113 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
7114 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007115 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007116 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
7117
7118 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
7119 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
7120 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
7121 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02007122 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
7123 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
7124 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007125
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02007126 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
7127 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
7128 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
7129 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
7130 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
7131 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007132
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01007133 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
7134 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007135
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007136 Example :
7137 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
7138 frontend www
7139 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
7140
7141 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
7142
7143
7144monitor-uri <uri>
7145 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7147 yes | yes | yes | no
7148 Arguments :
7149 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7150 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7151
7152 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7153 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7154 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7155 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7156 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7157 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7158 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7159 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7160
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007161 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007162 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7163 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7164 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7165 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7166 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7167 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007168
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007169 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7170 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7171 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7172 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7173
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007174 Example :
7175 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7176 frontend www
7177 mode http
7178 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7179
7180 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
7181
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007182
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007183option abortonclose
7184no option abortonclose
7185 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7187 yes | no | yes | yes
7188 Arguments : none
7189
7190 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7191 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7192 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7193 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007194 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007195 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7196 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7197 encountered while delivering the response.
7198
7199 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7200 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7201 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7202 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7203 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7204 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007205 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007206 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007207 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007208 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7209 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7210 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7211
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007212 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7213 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007214 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7215 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7216 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7217 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7218 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7219 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007220 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007221
7222 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7223 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7224
7225 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7226
7227
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007228option accept-invalid-http-request
7229no option accept-invalid-http-request
7230 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7232 yes | yes | yes | no
7233 Arguments : none
7234
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007235 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007236 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007237 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007238 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7239 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7240 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7241 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7242 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007243 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7244 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7245 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7246 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007247 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007248 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007249 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7250 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7251 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007252
7253 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7254 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7255 been confirmed.
7256
7257 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7258 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007259 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7260 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007261 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7262
7263 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7264 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7265
7266 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7267 stats socket.
7268
7269
7270option accept-invalid-http-response
7271no option accept-invalid-http-response
7272 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7274 yes | no | yes | yes
7275 Arguments : none
7276
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007277 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007278 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007279 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007280 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7281 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7282 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7283 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7284 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007285 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7286 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7287 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007288
7289 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7290 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7291 been confirmed.
7292
7293 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7294 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7295 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7296 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7297
7298 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7299 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7300
7301 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7302 stats socket.
7303
7304
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007305option allbackups
7306no option allbackups
7307 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7309 yes | no | yes | yes
7310 Arguments : none
7311
7312 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7313 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7314 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7315 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7316 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7317 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7318 order between the backup servers anymore.
7319
7320 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7321 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7322
7323 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7324 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7325
7326
7327option checkcache
7328no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007329 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7331 yes | no | yes | yes
7332 Arguments : none
7333
7334 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7335 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007336 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007337 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7338 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007339 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007340
7341 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007342 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007343 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007344 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7345 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007346 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007347 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007348 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7349 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007350 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007351 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7352 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007353 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007354 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7355 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7356 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7357 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7358 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7359 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7360 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7361 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7362 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7363
7364 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007365 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7366 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7367 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7368 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007369
7370 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7371 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007372 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007373 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007374
7375 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7376 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7377
7378
7379option clitcpka
7380no option clitcpka
7381 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7383 yes | yes | yes | no
7384 Arguments : none
7385
7386 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7387 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007388 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007389 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7390
7391 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7392 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7393 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7394 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7395
7396 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7397 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7398 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7399 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7400 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7401
7402 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7403
7404 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7405 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7406 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7407
7408 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7409 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7410
7411 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7412
7413
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007414option contstats
7415 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7417 yes | yes | yes | no
7418 Arguments : none
7419
7420 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7421 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7422 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7423 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007424 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7425 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7426 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7427 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7428 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007429
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007430option disable-h2-upgrade
7431no option disable-h2-upgrade
7432 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7433 connection.
7434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7435 yes | yes | yes | no
7436 Arguments : none
7437
7438 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7439 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7440 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7441 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7442 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7443 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7444 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7445 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7446
7447 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7448 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007449
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007450option dontlog-normal
7451no option dontlog-normal
7452 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7454 yes | yes | yes | no
7455 Arguments : none
7456
7457 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7458 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7459 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7460 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7461 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7462 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7463 logged.
7464
7465 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7466 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7467 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7468
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007469 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007470 logging.
7471
7472
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007473option dontlognull
7474no option dontlognull
7475 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7477 yes | yes | yes | no
7478 Arguments : none
7479
7480 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7481 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7482 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7483 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7484 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7485 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007486 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7487 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7488 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007489
7490 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007491 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007492 would not be logged.
7493
7494 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7495 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7496
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007497 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
7498 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007499
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007500
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007501option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007502 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7504 yes | yes | yes | yes
7505 Arguments :
7506 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7507 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007508 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007509 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007510
7511 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7512 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7513 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7514 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7515 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7516 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7517 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007518 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7519 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7520 possible that the client has already brought one.
7521
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007522 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007523 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007524 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007525 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007526 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007527 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007528
7529 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7530 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7531 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7532 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7533 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7534 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7535 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7536
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007537 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7538 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7539 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7540 are under the control of the end-user.
7541
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007542 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007543 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7544 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007545 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7546 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7547 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007548
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007549 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007550 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7551 frontend www
7552 mode http
7553 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7554
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007555 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7556 backend www
7557 mode http
7558 option forwardfor header X-Client
7559
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007560 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007561 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007562
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007563
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007564option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7565no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7566 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7568 yes | yes | yes | no
7569 Arguments : none
7570
7571 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7572 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7573 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7574 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7575 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7576 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7577 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7578
7579 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7580 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7581 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7582 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7583 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7584 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7585 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7586 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7587 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7588 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7589
7590 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7591
7592 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7593 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7594
7595 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7596 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7597
7598
7599option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7600no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7601 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7603 yes | no | yes | yes
7604 Arguments : none
7605
7606 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7607 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7608 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7609 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7610 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7611 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7612 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7613
7614 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7615 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7616 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7617 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7618 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7619 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7620 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7621 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7622 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7623 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7624
7625 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7626
7627 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7628 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7629
7630 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7631 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7632
7633
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007634option http-buffer-request
7635no option http-buffer-request
7636 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7638 yes | yes | yes | yes
7639 Arguments : none
7640
7641 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7642 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7643 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7644 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7645 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7646 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007647 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7648 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7649 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7650 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007651
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007652 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007653
7654
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007655option http-ignore-probes
7656no option http-ignore-probes
7657 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7659 yes | yes | yes | no
7660 Arguments : none
7661
7662 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7663 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7664 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7665 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7666 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7667 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7668 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7669 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7670 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007671 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7672 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007673 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7674
7675 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7676 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7677 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7678 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7679 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7680 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7681 are often the only way to detect them.
7682
7683 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7684 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7685
7686 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7687
7688
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007689option http-keep-alive
7690no option http-keep-alive
7691 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7693 yes | yes | yes | yes
7694 Arguments : none
7695
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007696 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7697 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007698 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7699 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007700 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7701 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7702 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007703
7704 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7705 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007706 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7707 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7708 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7709 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7710 situations where this option may be useful :
7711
7712 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007713 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007714
7715 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7716 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7717
7718 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7719 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
7720 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
7721 request.
7722
7723 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
7724 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007725 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
7726 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
7727 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007728
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007729 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7730 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7731 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7732 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
7733 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7734 not set.
7735
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007736 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7737 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
7738 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007739
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007740 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007741 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007742 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007743
7744
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007745option http-no-delay
7746no option http-no-delay
7747 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7749 yes | yes | yes | yes
7750 Arguments : none
7751
7752 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7753 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7754 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7755 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7756 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7757 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7758 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7759 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7760 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7761 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7762 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7763 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7764 affected.
7765
7766 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7767 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7768 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7769 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7770 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7771 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7772 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7773 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7774 latency environments.
7775
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007776 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7777
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007778
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007779option http-pretend-keepalive
7780no option http-pretend-keepalive
7781 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007783 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007784 Arguments : none
7785
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007786 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007787 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7788 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7789 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7790 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7791 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7792 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7793 consider the response complete.
7794
7795 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7796 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7797 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7798 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007799 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007800 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7801
7802 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7803 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7804 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7805 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7806 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7807 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7808 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7809
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007810 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7811 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7812 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7813 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7814 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7815 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007816
7817 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7818 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7819
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007820 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007821 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007822
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007823
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007824option http-server-close
7825no option http-server-close
7826 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7828 yes | yes | yes | yes
7829 Arguments : none
7830
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007831 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7832 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7833 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7834 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007835 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7836 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7837 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7838 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7839 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7840 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7841 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7842 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7843 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7844 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7845 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007846
7847 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7848 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7849 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7850 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007851 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7852 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007853
7854 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7855 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007856 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7857 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7858 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007859
7860 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7861 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7862
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007863 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7864 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007865
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007866option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007867no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007868 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7870 yes | yes | yes | no
7871 Arguments : none
7872
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007873 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007874 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7875 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7876 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7877 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7878 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7879 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7880
7881 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7882 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007883 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7884 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7885 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007886
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007887 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7888 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7889 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7890 front of an existing proxy.
7891
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007892 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7893
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007894 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007895
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007896option httpchk
7897option httpchk <uri>
7898option httpchk <method> <uri>
7899option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007900 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7902 yes | no | yes | yes
7903 Arguments :
7904 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7905 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7906 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7907 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7908 ones.
7909
7910 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7911 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7912 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7913
7914 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7915 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7916 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007917 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007918
7919 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7920 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7921 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7922 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7923 the lack of any response.
7924
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007925 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
7926 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
7927 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
7928 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
7929
7930 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
7931 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
7932 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007933
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007934 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
7935 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007936 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007937 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007938 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007939
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007940 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7941 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7942 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7943 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7944
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007945 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007946 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7947 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7948 backend https_relay
7949 mode tcp
7950 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
7951 http-check send hdr Host www
7952 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007953
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007954 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7955 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7956 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007957
7958
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007959option httpclose
7960no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007961 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7963 yes | yes | yes | yes
7964 Arguments : none
7965
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007966 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7967 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7968 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7969 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007970 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007971
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007972 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7973 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007974 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007975 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7976 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007977
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007978 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7979 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7980 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007981
7982 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7983 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007984 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7985 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7986 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007987
7988 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7989 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7990
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007991 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007992
7993
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007994option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007995 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007997 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007998 Arguments :
7999 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8000 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8001 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008002 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008003 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008004
8005 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8006 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8007 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8008 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8009 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8010 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8011 ports.
8012
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008013 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8014 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008015
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008016 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8017
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008018 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008019
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008020
8021option http_proxy
8022no option http_proxy
8023 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8025 yes | yes | yes | yes
8026 Arguments : none
8027
8028 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8029 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8030 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8031 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8032 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8033
8034 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8035 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008036 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8037 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008038
8039 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8040 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8041
8042 Example :
8043 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8044 backend direct_forward
8045 option httpclose
8046 option http_proxy
8047
8048 See also : "option httpclose"
8049
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008050
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008051option independent-streams
8052no option independent-streams
8053 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8055 yes | yes | yes | yes
8056 Arguments : none
8057
8058 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8059 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8060 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8061 receive data or not.
8062
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008063 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008064 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8065 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8066 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8067 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8068 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8069 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8070 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8071 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8072 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8073 socket buffers.
8074
8075 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8076 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8077 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8078 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8079 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8080
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008081 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008082
8083
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008084option ldap-check
8085 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8087 yes | no | yes | yes
8088 Arguments : none
8089
8090 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8091 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8092 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8093 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8094
8095 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8096 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8097
8098 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8099 configure it.
8100
8101 Example :
8102 option ldap-check
8103
8104 See also : "option httpchk"
8105
8106
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008107option external-check
8108 Use external processes for server health checks
8109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8110 yes | no | yes | yes
8111
8112 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8113 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8114 command".
8115
8116 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8117
8118 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8119
8120
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008121option log-health-checks
8122no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008123 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8125 yes | no | yes | yes
8126 Arguments : none
8127
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008128 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8129 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8130 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008131
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008132 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8133 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8134 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8135 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8136 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8137
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008138 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008139 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008140
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008141 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8142 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8143 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008144
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008145
8146option log-separate-errors
8147no option log-separate-errors
8148 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8150 yes | yes | yes | no
8151 Arguments : none
8152
8153 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8154 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8155 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8156 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8157 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8158 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8159 provides very important information.
8160
8161 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8162 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8163 error logs.
8164
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008165 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008166 logging.
8167
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008168
8169option logasap
8170no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008171 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8173 yes | yes | yes | no
8174 Arguments : none
8175
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008176 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8177 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8178 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8179 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8180
8181 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8182 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8183 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8184 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8185 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008186 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008187 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8188 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8189 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8190 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008191 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008192
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008193 Examples :
8194 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8195 mode http
8196 option httplog
8197 option logasap
8198 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8199
8200 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8201 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8202 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8203 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8204
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008205 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008206 logging.
8207
8208
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008209option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008210 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8212 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008213 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008214 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8215 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008216 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8217 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008218
8219 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8220 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008221 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008222 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8223 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8224 in the MySQL table, like this :
8225
8226 USE mysql;
8227 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8228 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8229
8230 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008231 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008232 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8233 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8234 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8235 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8236 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8237 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8238 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8239
8240 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8241 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008242
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008243 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008244
8245 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8246 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8247 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8248 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008249 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8250 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008251
8252 See also: "option httpchk"
8253
8254
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008255option nolinger
8256no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008257 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008258 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8259 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008260 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008261
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008262 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008263 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8264 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8265 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8266 connections.
8267
8268 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8269 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
8270 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
8271 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
8272 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
8273 this too.
8274
8275 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
8276 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
8277 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
8278
8279 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8280 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
8281 for servers.
8282
8283 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8284 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8285
8286
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008287option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8288 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8290 yes | yes | yes | yes
8291 Arguments :
8292 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8293 matching <network>
8294 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8295 header name.
8296
8297 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8298 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8299 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8300 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8301 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8302 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8303 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8304 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8305 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8306 possible that the client has already brought one.
8307
8308 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8309 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8310 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8311 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8312 header and requires different one.
8313
8314 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8315 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8316 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8317 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8318 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8319 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8320 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8321
8322 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8323 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8324 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8325 both are defined.
8326
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008327 Examples :
8328 # Original Destination address
8329 frontend www
8330 mode http
8331 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8332
8333 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8334 backend www
8335 mode http
8336 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8337
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008338 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008339
8340
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008341option persist
8342no option persist
8343 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8344 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8345 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008346 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008347
8348 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8349 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8350 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8351 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8352 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8353 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8354 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8355 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8356 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8357 redirected to another valid server.
8358
8359 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8360 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8361
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008362 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008363
8364
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008365option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8366 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8368 yes | no | yes | yes
8369 Arguments :
8370 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8371 PostgreSQL server.
8372
8373 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8374 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8375 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8376 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8377
8378 See also: "option httpchk"
8379
8380
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008381option prefer-last-server
8382no option prefer-last-server
8383 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8384 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8385 yes | no | yes | yes
8386 Arguments : none
8387
8388 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8389 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8390 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8391 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8392 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8393 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8394 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8395 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8396 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008397 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8398 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008399 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8400 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8401 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008402 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8403 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8404 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008405
8406 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8407 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8408
8409 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8410
8411
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008412option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008413option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008414no option redispatch
8415 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8416 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8417 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008418 Arguments :
8419 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8420 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8421 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008422 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008423 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008424 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008425 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8426 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8427 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8428
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008429
8430 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8431 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8432 be able to access the service anymore.
8433
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008434 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8435 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008436
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008437 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8438 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8439 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8440 following order:
8441
8442 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8443
8444 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8445 list, or
8446
8447 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8448
8449 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8450 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8451
8452 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8453 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8454 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8455 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8456
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008457 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008458 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8459 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008460
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008461 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8462 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8463
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008464 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008465
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008466
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008467option redis-check
8468 Use redis health checks for server testing
8469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8470 yes | no | yes | yes
8471 Arguments : none
8472
8473 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8474 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8475 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8476 find the "+PONG" response message.
8477
8478 Example :
8479 option redis-check
8480
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008481 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008482
8483
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008484option smtpchk
8485option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8486 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8488 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008489 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008490 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008491 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008492 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8493
8494 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8495 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8496 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8497
8498 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8499 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8500 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8501 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8502 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8503 dead server.
8504
8505 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8506 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008507 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008508 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8509
8510 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8511 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8512 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8513 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008514 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008515
8516 Example :
8517 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8518
8519 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8520
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008521
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008522option socket-stats
8523no option socket-stats
8524
8525 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8527 yes | yes | yes | no
8528
8529 Arguments : none
8530
8531
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008532option splice-auto
8533no option splice-auto
8534 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8536 yes | yes | yes | yes
8537 Arguments : none
8538
8539 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8540 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008541 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008542 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008543 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008544 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8545 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8546 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8547 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8548
8549 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8550 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8551 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8552 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8553 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8554 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8555 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8556 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8557 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8558 keyword.
8559
8560 Example :
8561 option splice-auto
8562
8563 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8564 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8565
8566 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8567 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8568
8569
8570option splice-request
8571no option splice-request
8572 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8574 yes | yes | yes | yes
8575 Arguments : none
8576
8577 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008578 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008579 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8580 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8581 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8582 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8583
8584 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8585
8586 Example :
8587 option splice-request
8588
8589 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8590 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8591
8592 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8593 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8594
8595
8596option splice-response
8597no option splice-response
8598 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8600 yes | yes | yes | yes
8601 Arguments : none
8602
8603 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008604 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008605 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8606 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8607 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8608 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8609
8610 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8611
8612 Example :
8613 option splice-response
8614
8615 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8616 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8617
8618 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8619 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8620
8621
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008622option spop-check
8623 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8625 no | no | no | yes
8626 Arguments : none
8627
8628 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8629 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8630 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8631 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8632
8633 Example :
8634 option spop-check
8635
8636 See also : "option httpchk"
8637
8638
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008639option srvtcpka
8640no option srvtcpka
8641 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8643 yes | no | yes | yes
8644 Arguments : none
8645
8646 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8647 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008648 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008649 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8650
8651 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8652 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8653 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8654 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8655
8656 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8657 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8658 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8659 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8660 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8661
8662 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8663
8664 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8665 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8666 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8667
8668 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8669 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8670
8671 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8672
8673
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008674option ssl-hello-chk
8675 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8677 yes | no | yes | yes
8678 Arguments : none
8679
8680 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8681 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8682 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8683 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8684 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8685 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8686 hello message.
8687
8688 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8689 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8690 messages, which is appreciable.
8691
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008692 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8693 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8694 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008695
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008696 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8697
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008698
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008699option tcp-check
8700 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8701 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8702 yes | no | yes | yes
8703
8704 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
8705 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
8706
8707 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
8708 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
8709 attempt, which remains the default mode.
8710
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008711 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008712 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
8713 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
8714 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
8715 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
8716 only.
8717
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008718 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008719 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
8720 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
8721 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
8722 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
8723
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008724 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008725 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
8726 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008727 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008728 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
8729 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
8730 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
8731 the respective protocols.
8732 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008733 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008734
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008735 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008736
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008737 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
8738 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
8739 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
8740 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008741
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008742 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
8743 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
8744 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01008745
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008746
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008747 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008748 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008749 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008750 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008751
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008752 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008753 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008754 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008755
8756 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8757 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008758 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008759 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008760 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008761 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008762 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008763 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008764 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8765 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008766 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008767 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8768 tcp-check expect string +OK
8769
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008770 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008771 (send many headers before analyzing)
8772 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008773 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008774 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8775 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8776 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8777 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008778 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008779
8780
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008781 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008782
8783
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008784option tcp-smart-accept
8785no option tcp-smart-accept
8786 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8788 yes | yes | yes | no
8789 Arguments : none
8790
8791 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8792 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8793 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8794 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8795 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8796 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8797
8798 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8799 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8800 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8801 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8802
8803 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8804 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8805 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008806 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008807
8808 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8809 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8810 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8811
8812 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8813 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8814 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8815
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008816 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8817
8818
8819option tcp-smart-connect
8820no option tcp-smart-connect
8821 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8823 yes | no | yes | yes
8824 Arguments : none
8825
8826 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8827 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8828 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8829 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8830 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8831
8832 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8833 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8834 complex.
8835
8836 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8837 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8838 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8839
8840 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8841 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8842
8843 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8844
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008845
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008846option tcpka
8847 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8849 yes | yes | yes | yes
8850 Arguments : none
8851
8852 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8853 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008854 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008855 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8856
8857 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8858 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8859 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8860 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8861
8862 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8863 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8864 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8865 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8866 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8867
8868 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8869
8870 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8871 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8872 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8873 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8874 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8875 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8876 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8877 backends.
8878
8879 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8880
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008881
8882option tcplog
8883 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008885 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008886 Arguments : none
8887
8888 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8889 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8890 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8891 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8892 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8893 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8894 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8895 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8896
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008897 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8898
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008899 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008900
8901
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008902option transparent
8903no option transparent
8904 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008906 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008907 Arguments : none
8908
8909 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8910 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8911 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8912 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8913 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8914 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8915 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8916 appropriate server.
8917
8918 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8919 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8920
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008921 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008922 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008923
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008924
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008925external-check command <command>
8926 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8928 yes | no | yes | yes
8929
8930 Arguments :
8931 <command> is the external command to run
8932
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008933 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8934
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008935 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008936
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008937 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8938 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8939 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8940 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8941 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8942 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008943
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008944 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8945
8946 Environment variables :
8947 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8948 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8949
8950 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8951
8952 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8953
8954 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8955 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8956 for a UNIX socket).
8957
8958 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8959
8960 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8961
8962 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8963
8964 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8965
8966 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8967
8968 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8969 socket).
8970
8971 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8972 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8973
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008974 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8975
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008976 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8977 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8978 failed.
8979
8980 Example :
8981 external-check command /bin/true
8982
8983 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8984
8985
8986external-check path <path>
8987 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8989 yes | no | yes | yes
8990
8991 Arguments :
8992 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8993
8994 The default path is "".
8995
8996 Example :
8997 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8998
8999 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9000 "external-check command"
9001
9002
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009003persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009004persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009005 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9007 yes | no | yes | yes
9008 Arguments :
9009 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009010 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9011 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009012
9013 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9014 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009015 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009016 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9017 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9018 forwarded to this server.
9019
9020 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9021 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9022 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009023 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009024 a single "listen" section.
9025
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009026 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9027 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9028 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9029
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009030 Example :
9031 listen tse-farm
9032 bind :3389
9033 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9034 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9035 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9036 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9037 persist rdp-cookie
9038 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009039 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009040 balance rdp-cookie
9041 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9042 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9043
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009044 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9045 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009046
9047
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009048rate-limit sessions <rate>
9049 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9051 yes | yes | yes | no
9052 Arguments :
9053 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9054 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9055
9056 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9057 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9058 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9059 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9060 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9061 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9062
9063 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9064 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9065 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9066 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9067
9068 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9069 listen smtp
9070 mode tcp
9071 bind :25
9072 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009073 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009074
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009075 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9076 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9077 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009078
9079 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9080
9081
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009082redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9083redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9084redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009085 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9087 no | yes | yes | yes
9088
9089 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009090 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009091
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009092 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009093 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009094 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9095 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9096 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009097
9098 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9099 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9100 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9101 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9102 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009103 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9104 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9105 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9106 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009107
9108 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9109 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9110 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9111 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9112 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9113 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009114 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009115 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009116 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9117 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9118 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009119
9120 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009121 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9122 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9123 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009124 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009125 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9126 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9127 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9128 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009129
9130 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009131 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009132
9133 - "drop-query"
9134 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9135 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9136 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9137 with a location-type redirect.
9138
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009139 - "append-slash"
9140 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9141 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9142 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9143 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9144
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009145 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9146 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9147 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9148 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9149 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9150 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9151 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9152
9153 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9154 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9155 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9156 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9157 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9158 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9159 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009160
9161 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9162 acl clear dst_port 80
9163 acl secure dst_port 8080
9164 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009165 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009166 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009167 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9168
9169 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009170 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9171 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9172 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009173 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009174
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009175 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9176 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9177 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9178
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009179 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009180 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009181
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009182 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009183 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9184 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9185 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009186
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009187 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009188
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009189
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009190retries <value>
9191 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9192 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9193 yes | no | yes | yes
9194 Arguments :
9195 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9196 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9197 default value is 3.
9198
9199 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9200 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9201 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9202
9203 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009204 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9205 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009206
9207 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9208 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9209
9210 See also : "option redispatch"
9211
9212
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009213retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009214 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9215 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9216 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009217 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9218 yes | no | yes | yes
9219 Arguments :
9220 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9221 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9222 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9223 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9224
9225 none never retry
9226
9227 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9228 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9229
9230 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9231 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9232 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9233 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9234 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9235 processing the request.
9236
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009237 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9238 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9239 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9240 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9241 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9242 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9243 overflow attack for example).
9244
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009245 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9246 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9247 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9248 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9249 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9250 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9251 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9252 amplify denial of service attacks.
9253
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009254 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9255 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9256 considered to be safe to retry.
9257
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009258 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
9259 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
9260 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
9261 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
9262
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009263 all-retryable-errors
9264 retry request for any error that are considered
9265 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9266 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9267 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9268
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009269 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9270 not cumulative.
9271
9272 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9273 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9274 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9275 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9276
9277 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9278 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9279 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9280 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9281 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9282 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9283 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9284 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9285 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9286 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9287 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9288 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9289
9290 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9291 should not use this directive.
9292
9293 The default is "conn-failure".
9294
9295 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9296
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009297server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009298 Declare a server in a backend
9299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9300 no | no | yes | yes
9301 Arguments :
9302 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009303 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009304 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009305
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009306 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9307 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9308 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9309 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009310 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9311 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9312 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9313 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9314 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009315 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9316 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9317 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9318 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9319 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9320 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9321 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009322 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009323 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9324 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9325 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9326 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9327 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9328 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009329 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9330 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009331 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9332 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009333
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009334 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009335 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9336 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9337 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9338 adding this value to the client's port.
9339
9340 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9341 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009342 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009343
9344 Examples :
9345 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9346 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009347 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009348 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9349 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9350 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009351
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009352 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9353 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9354 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9355 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9356 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9357
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009358 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9359 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009360
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009361server-state-file-name [<file>]
9362 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9363 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9364 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9365 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9366 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9367 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9368
9369 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9370 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9371
9372 global
9373 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9374
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009375 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009376 load-server-state-from-file
9377
9378 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9379 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009380
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009381server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9382 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9383 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9385 no | no | yes | yes
9386
9387 Arguments:
9388 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9389
9390 <num | range>
9391 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9392 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9393 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9394 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9395
9396 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9397
9398 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9399
9400 <params*>
9401 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9402 keyword.
9403
9404 Examples:
9405 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9406 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9407 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9408
9409 # or
9410 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9411
9412 # would be equivalent to:
9413 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9414 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9415 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9416
9417
9418
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009419source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009420source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009421source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009422 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9424 yes | no | yes | yes
9425 Arguments :
9426 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9427 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009428
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009429 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009430 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9431 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9432 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9433 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9434 supported prefixes are :
9435 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9436 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9437 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009438 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009439 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9440 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009441
9442 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9443 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009444 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9445 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9446 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009447
9448 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9449 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9450 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9451 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9452 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9453 <addr>.
9454
9455 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9456 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9457 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9458 port.
9459
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009460 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9461 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9462 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9463 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009464 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009465 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9466 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9467 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9468 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9469 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9470 HTTP header.
9471
9472 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9473 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009474 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009475 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9476 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9477 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9478 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9479 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9480 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9481 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9482
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009483 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9484 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9485 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9486 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9487 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9488 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9489
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009490 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9491 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9492 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9493 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9494
9495 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9496 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9497 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9498 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9499 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9500 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9501
9502 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9503 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9504 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9505 there are two methods :
9506
9507 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9508 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9509 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9510 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9511 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9512 of the client ranges may be used.
9513
9514 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9515 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9516 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9517 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9518 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9519 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9520 same session.
9521
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009522 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9523 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9524 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009525 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009526
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009527 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9528
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009529 Examples :
9530 backend private
9531 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9532 source 192.168.1.200
9533
9534 backend transparent_ssl1
9535 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9536 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9537
9538 backend transparent_ssl2
9539 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9540 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9541 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9542
9543 backend transparent_ssl3
9544 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9545 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9546 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9547
9548 backend transparent_smtp
9549 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9550 # with Tproxy version 4.
9551 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9552
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009553 backend transparent_http
9554 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9555 # proxy.
9556 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9557
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009558 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009559 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9560
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009561
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009562srvtcpka-cnt <count>
9563 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
9564 the connection on the server side.
9565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9566 yes | no | yes | yes
9567 Arguments :
9568 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
9569
9570 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
9571 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009572 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9573 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009574
9575 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9576
9577
9578srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
9579 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
9580 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
9581 server side.
9582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9583 yes | no | yes | yes
9584 Arguments :
9585 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
9586 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
9587 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
9588 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
9589
9590 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
9591 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009592 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9593 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009594
9595 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9596
9597
9598srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
9599 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
9600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9601 yes | no | yes | yes
9602 Arguments :
9603 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
9604 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
9605 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
9606 document.
9607
9608 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
9609 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009610 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9611 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009612
9613 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
9614
9615
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009616stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9617 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009619 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009620
9621 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9622 matched.
9623
9624 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9625 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9626
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009627 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9628 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009629 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009630
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009631 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9632 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9633 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9634 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009635
9636 Example :
9637 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9638 backend stats_localhost
9639 stats enable
9640 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9641
9642 Example :
9643 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9644 backend stats_auth
9645 stats enable
9646 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9647 stats admin if TRUE
9648
9649 Example :
9650 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9651 userlist stats-auth
9652 group admin users admin
9653 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9654 group readonly users haproxy
9655 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9656
9657 backend stats_auth
9658 stats enable
9659 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9660 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9661 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9662 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9663
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009664 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9665 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9666 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009667
9668
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009669stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9670 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009672 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009673 Arguments :
9674 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9675
9676 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9677
9678 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9679 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9680 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9681 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9682 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9683 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9684
9685 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9686 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9687 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009688 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009689
9690 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9691 report using "stats scope".
9692
9693 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9694 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9695 unobvious parameters.
9696
9697 Example :
9698 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9699 backend public_www
9700 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9701 stats enable
9702 stats hide-version
9703 stats scope .
9704 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009705 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009706 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9707 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9708
9709 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9710 backend private_monitoring
9711 stats enable
9712 stats uri /admin?stats
9713 stats refresh 5s
9714
9715 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
9716
9717
9718stats enable
9719 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
9720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009721 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009722 Arguments : none
9723
9724 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
9725 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
9726 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
9727 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
9728 - stats auth : no authentication
9729 - stats scope : no restriction
9730
9731 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9732 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9733 unobvious parameters.
9734
9735 Example :
9736 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9737 backend public_www
9738 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9739 stats enable
9740 stats hide-version
9741 stats scope .
9742 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009743 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009744 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9745 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9746
9747 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9748 backend private_monitoring
9749 stats enable
9750 stats uri /admin?stats
9751 stats refresh 5s
9752
9753 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9754
9755
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009756stats hide-version
9757 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009759 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009760 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009761
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009762 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9763 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9764 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9765 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9766 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9767 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009768
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009769 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9770 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9771 unobvious parameters.
9772
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009773 Example :
9774 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9775 backend public_www
9776 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009777 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009778 stats hide-version
9779 stats scope .
9780 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009781 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009782 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9783 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009784
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009785 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9786 backend private_monitoring
9787 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009788 stats uri /admin?stats
9789 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009790
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009791 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009792
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009793
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009794stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9795 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9796 Access control for statistics
9797
9798 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9799 no | no | yes | yes
9800
9801 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9802 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9803 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9804 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9805 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9806 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9807
9808 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9809 instance.
9810
9811 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9812 about ACL usage.
9813
9814
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009815stats realm <realm>
9816 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009818 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009819 Arguments :
9820 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9821 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9822 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9823
9824 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9825 using a backslash ('\').
9826
9827 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9828 only related to authentication.
9829
9830 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9831 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9832 unobvious parameters.
9833
9834 Example :
9835 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9836 backend public_www
9837 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9838 stats enable
9839 stats hide-version
9840 stats scope .
9841 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009842 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009843 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9844 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9845
9846 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9847 backend private_monitoring
9848 stats enable
9849 stats uri /admin?stats
9850 stats refresh 5s
9851
9852 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9853
9854
9855stats refresh <delay>
9856 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009858 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009859 Arguments :
9860 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9861 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9862 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9863 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9864 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9865 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9866
9867 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9868 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9869 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -05009870 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009871
9872 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9873 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9874 unobvious parameters.
9875
9876 Example :
9877 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9878 backend public_www
9879 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9880 stats enable
9881 stats hide-version
9882 stats scope .
9883 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009884 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009885 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9886 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9887
9888 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9889 backend private_monitoring
9890 stats enable
9891 stats uri /admin?stats
9892 stats refresh 5s
9893
9894 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9895
9896
9897stats scope { <name> | "." }
9898 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009900 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009901 Arguments :
9902 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9903 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9904 section in which the statement appears.
9905
9906 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9907 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9908 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9909 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9910 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9911 exists.
9912
9913 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9914 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9915 unobvious parameters.
9916
9917 Example :
9918 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9919 backend public_www
9920 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9921 stats enable
9922 stats hide-version
9923 stats scope .
9924 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009925 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009926 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9927 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9928
9929 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9930 backend private_monitoring
9931 stats enable
9932 stats uri /admin?stats
9933 stats refresh 5s
9934
9935 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9936
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009937
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009938stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009939 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009941 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009942
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009943 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009944 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9945
9946 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9947 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9948
9949 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9950 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009951 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009952
9953 Example :
9954 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9955 backend private_monitoring
9956 stats enable
9957 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9958 stats uri /admin?stats
9959 stats refresh 5s
9960
9961 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9962 global section.
9963
9964
9965stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009966 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9968 yes | yes | yes | yes
9969 Arguments : none
9970
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009971 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009972 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9973 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9974 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9975 - IP (socket, server)
9976 - cookie (backend, server)
9977
9978 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9979 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009980 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009981
9982 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9983
9984
9985stats show-node [ <name> ]
9986 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009988 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009989 Arguments:
9990 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9991 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9992
9993 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9994 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009995 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009996
9997 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9998 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9999 unobvious parameters.
10000
10001 Example:
10002 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10003 backend private_monitoring
10004 stats enable
10005 stats show-node Europe-1
10006 stats uri /admin?stats
10007 stats refresh 5s
10008
10009 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10010 section.
10011
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010012
10013stats uri <prefix>
10014 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010016 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010017 Arguments :
10018 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10019 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10020 query string.
10021
10022 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10023 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10024 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10025 possible to reach it in the application.
10026
10027 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010028 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010029 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10030 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10031 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10032 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10033
10034 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10035 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10036 an address or a port to statistics only.
10037
10038 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10039 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10040 unobvious parameters.
10041
10042 Example :
10043 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10044 backend public_www
10045 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10046 stats enable
10047 stats hide-version
10048 stats scope .
10049 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010050 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010051 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10052 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10053
10054 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10055 backend private_monitoring
10056 stats enable
10057 stats uri /admin?stats
10058 stats refresh 5s
10059
10060 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10061
10062
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010063stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10064 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010066 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010067
10068 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010069 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010070 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010071 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010072 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10073
10074 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10075 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10076 the "stick-table" statement.
10077
10078 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10079 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10080 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10081 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10082 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10083
10084 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10085 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10086 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10087 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10088 transformation rules.
10089
10090 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10091 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10092 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10093 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10094 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10095 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10096 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10097
10098 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10099 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10100 ACL based conditions.
10101
10102 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10103 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10104 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10105 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10106
10107 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10108 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10109 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10110 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10111
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010112 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10113 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010114 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010115
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010116 Example :
10117 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10118 # last 30 minutes
10119 backend pop
10120 mode tcp
10121 balance roundrobin
10122 stick store-request src
10123 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10124 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10125 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10126
10127 backend smtp
10128 mode tcp
10129 balance roundrobin
10130 stick match src table pop
10131 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10132 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10133
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010134 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010135 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010136
10137
10138stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10139 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10141 no | no | yes | yes
10142
10143 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10144 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10145 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10146 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10147
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010148 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10149 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010150 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010151
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010152 Examples :
10153 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010154 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010155
10156 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10157 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10158 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10159
10160
10161 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10162 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10163 backend http
10164 mode http
10165 balance roundrobin
10166 stick on src table https
10167 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10168 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10169 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10170
10171 backend https
10172 mode tcp
10173 balance roundrobin
10174 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10175 stick on src
10176 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10177 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10178
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010179 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010180
10181
10182stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10183 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10185 no | no | yes | yes
10186
10187 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010188 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010189 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010190 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010191 server is selected.
10192
10193 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10194 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10195 the "stick-table" statement.
10196
10197 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10198 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10199 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10200 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10201 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10202 address.
10203
10204 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10205 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10206 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10207 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10208 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10209 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10210 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10211 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10212 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10213 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10214
10215 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10216 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10217 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10218 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10219 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10220 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10221 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10222
10223 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10224 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10225 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10226 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10227
10228 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10229 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10230 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10231 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10232 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10233 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010234 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10235 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10236 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10237 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10238 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10239 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010240
10241 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10242 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10243 the request.
10244
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010245 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10246 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010247 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010248
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010249 Example :
10250 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10251 # last 30 minutes
10252 backend pop
10253 mode tcp
10254 balance roundrobin
10255 stick store-request src
10256 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10257 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10258 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10259
10260 backend smtp
10261 mode tcp
10262 balance roundrobin
10263 stick match src table pop
10264 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10265 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10266
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010267 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010268 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010269
10270
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010271stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010272 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10273 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010274 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010276 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010277
10278 Arguments :
10279 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10280 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10281 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10282 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10283
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010284 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10285 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10286 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10287 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10288
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010289 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10290 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10291 instance.
10292
10293 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10294 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10295 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10296 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10297 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10298 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010299 to 32 characters.
10300
10301 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10302 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10303 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010304 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010305 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10306 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010307
10308 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010309 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10310 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010311 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10312 increase.
10313
10314 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010315 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10316 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10317 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010318
10319 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10320 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10321 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10322 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010323 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010324 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10325 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10326 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10327 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10328 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10329 parameter (see below).
10330
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010331 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10332 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10333 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10334 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10335 soft restart.
10336
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010337 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10338 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010339
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010340 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10341 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10342 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10343 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010344 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010345 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010346 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10347 if not expiration delay is specified.
10348
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010349 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10350 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10351 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10352 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010353 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10354 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10355 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10356 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10357 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10358 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10359 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10360 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10361 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10362 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10363 types and their arguments.
10364
10365 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10366 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10367 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10368 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10369
10370 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10371 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10372 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010373 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010374
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010375 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10376 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10377 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010378 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010379 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010380 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010381
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010382 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10383 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10384 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10385 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10386
10387 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10388 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10389 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10390 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10391 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10392 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10393
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010394 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10395 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10396 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10397 they were received.
10398
10399 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10400 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10401 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10402 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10403 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10404
10405 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10406 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10407 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10408 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10409 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10410
10411 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10412 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10413 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10414
10415 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10416 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10417 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10418 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10419 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10420
10421 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10422 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10423 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10424 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10425 the client side.
10426
10427 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10428 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10429 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10430 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10431 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10432 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10433 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10434
10435 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10436 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10437 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10438 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10439 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10440 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010441 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010442
10443 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10444 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10445 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10446 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10447 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10448 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10449
10450 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010451 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010452 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10453 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10454
10455 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10456 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10457 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10458 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10459 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10460 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10461 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10462 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10463 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10464 recommended for better fairness.
10465
10466 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010467 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010468 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10469 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10470
10471 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10472 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10473 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10474 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10475 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10476 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10477 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10478 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10479 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10480 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010481
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010482 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10483 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010484 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10485 reference it.
10486
10487 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10488 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010489 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10490 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10491 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010492
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010493 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10494 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10495 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10496 something that can be ignored.
10497
10498 Example:
10499 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10500 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10501 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10502 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10503
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010504 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010505 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010506
10507
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010508stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010509 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10511 no | no | yes | yes
10512
10513 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010514 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010515 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010516 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010517 server is selected.
10518
10519 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10520 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10521 the "stick-table" statement.
10522
10523 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10524 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10525 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10526 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10527
10528 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10529 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10530 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10531 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10532 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10533 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010534 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010535 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10536 rules.
10537
10538 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10539 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10540 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10541 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10542 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10543 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10544 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10545
10546 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10547 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10548 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10549 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10550
10551 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10552 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10553 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10554 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10555 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10556 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010557 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10558 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10559 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10560 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10561 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10562 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10563 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10564 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10565 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010566
10567 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10568
10569 Example :
10570 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10571 backend https
10572 mode tcp
10573 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010574 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010575 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010576
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010577 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10578 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10579
10580 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10581 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10582 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10583
10584 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10585 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010586
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010587 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10588 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10589 # at offset 44.
10590
10591 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10592 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10593
10594 # Learn on response if server hello.
10595 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010596
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010597 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10598 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10599
10600 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10601 extraction.
10602
10603
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010604tcp-check comment <string>
10605 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10606 it fails.
10607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10608 yes | no | yes | yes
10609
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010610 Arguments :
10611 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10612 rule fails.
10613
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010614 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10615 user-friendly error reporting.
10616
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010617 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10618 "tcp-check expect".
10619
10620
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010621tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10622 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010623 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010624 Opens a new connection
10625 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010626 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010627
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010628 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010629 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10630
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010631 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010632 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010633
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010634 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010635 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10636 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010637 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010638
10639 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010640
10641 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10642
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010643 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10644
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010645 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10646
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010647 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10648
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010649 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10650 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10651 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10652 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10653
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010654 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10655 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10656 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10657 haproxy -vv.
10658
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010659 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010660
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010661 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10662 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10663 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10664
10665 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10666 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10667 of the sequence.
10668
10669 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10670 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10671 do.
10672
10673 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10674 unset-var or comment rules.
10675
10676 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010677 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10678 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10679 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10680 option tcp-check
10681 tcp-check connect
10682 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10683 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10684 tcp-check send \r\n
10685 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10686 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10687 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10688 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10689 tcp-check send \r\n
10690 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10691 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
10692
10693 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
10694 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010695 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010696 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10697 tcp-check connect port 143
10698 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10699 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
10700
10701 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
10702
10703
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010704tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010705 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010706 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010707 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010708 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010709 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010710 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010711
10712 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010713 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10714
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010715 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
10716 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
10717 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
10718 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
10719 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
10720 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
10721 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
10722 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
10723 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
10724 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
10725
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010726 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010727 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
10728 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010729 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
10730 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
10731 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
10732
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010733 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10734 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
10735 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010736 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
10737 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
10738 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
10739 example 404 with disable-on-404
10740 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
10741 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010742 By default "L7OK" is used.
10743
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010744 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10745 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010746 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
10747 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10748 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
10749 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10750 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
10751 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010752
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010753 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010754 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010755 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
10756 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10757 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10758 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010759 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
10760
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020010761 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10762 informational message reported in logs if the expect
10763 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
10764 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
10765
10766 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10767 informational message reported in logs if an error
10768 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
10769 log-format string.
10770
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010771 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
10772 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
10773 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10774 followed by some converters.
10775
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010776 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
10777 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
10778 with the usual backslash ('\').
10779 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010780 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010781 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
10782 used upper or lower case.
10783
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010784 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
10785
10786 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
10787 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10788 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
10789 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10790 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
10791 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
10792 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
10793 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
10794
10795 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
10796 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10797 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
10798 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10799 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
10800 expression.
10801
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010802 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
10803 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10804 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
10805 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
10806 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10807 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
10808
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010809 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
10810 in the response buffer. A health check response will
10811 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
10812 this exact hexadecimal string.
10813 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
10814
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010815 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
10816 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
10817 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
10818 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
10819 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
10820 size of the original response. As such, the expected
10821 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
10822 size.
10823
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010824 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
10825 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
10826 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
10827 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
10828 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
10829 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10830 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
10831 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
10832 in a binary string before matching the response's
10833 buffer.
10834
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010835 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
10836 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
10837 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
10838 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
10839 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
10840 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
10841 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
10842 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
10843 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
10844 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
10845 the null character.
10846
10847 Examples :
10848 # perform a POP check
10849 option tcp-check
10850 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10851
10852 # perform an IMAP check
10853 option tcp-check
10854 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10855
10856 # look for the redis master server
10857 option tcp-check
10858 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010859 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010860 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10861 tcp-check expect string role:master
10862 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10863 tcp-check expect string +OK
10864
10865
10866 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10867 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10868
10869
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010870tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
10871tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
10872 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
10873 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010874 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010875 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010876
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010877 Arguments :
10878 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10879
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010880 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
10881 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010882
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010883 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
10884 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010885
10886 Examples :
10887 # look for the redis master server
10888 option tcp-check
10889 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10890 tcp-check expect string role:master
10891
10892 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10893 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10894
10895
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010896tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
10897tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
10898 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
10899 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010900 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010901 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010902
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010903 Arguments :
10904 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010905
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010906 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
10907 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010908
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010909 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
10910 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
10911 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010912
10913 Examples :
10914 # redis check in binary
10915 option tcp-check
10916 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10917 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10918
10919
10920 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10921 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10922
10923
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010924tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010925 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010926 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010927 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010928
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010929 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010930 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10931 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10932 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10933 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10934 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10935 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10936 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10937 and '-'.
10938
10939 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
10940
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010941 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010942 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
10943
10944
10945tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010946 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010947 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010948 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010949
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010950 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010951 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10952 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10953 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10954 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10955 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10956 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10957 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10958 and '-'.
10959
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010960 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010961 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
10962
10963
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010964tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10965 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10967 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010968 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010969 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10970 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010971
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010972 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010973
10974 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10975 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010976 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10977 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10978 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10979 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10980 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10981 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010982
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010983 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10984 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10985 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10986 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010987
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010988 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010989 - accept :
10990 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10991 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10992 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010993
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010994 - reject :
10995 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10996 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10997 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10998 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10999 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11000 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11001 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11002 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11003 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11004 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11005 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011006 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011007
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011008 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11009 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11010 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11011 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11012 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11013 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11014 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11015 hosts.
11016
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011017 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11018 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11019 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11020 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11021 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11022 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11023 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11024 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11025
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011026 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11027 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11028 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11029 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11030 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11031 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11032 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11033 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11034 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011035 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11036 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011037
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011038 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011039 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011040 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11041 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11042 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011043 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011044 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
11045 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11046 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11047 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11048 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11049 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11050 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11051 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011052
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011053 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011054 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011055 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011056 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011057 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11058 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11059 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011060
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011061 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11062 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11063 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11064 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011065
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011066 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11067 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11068 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11069 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11070 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011071 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11072 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11073 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11074 layer7 information is extracted.
11075
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011076 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11077 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11078 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11079 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11080 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011081
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011082 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11083 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11084 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11085 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11086
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011087 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11088 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11089 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11090 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11091
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011092 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11093 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11094 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11095 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11096 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011097
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011098 - set-src <expr> :
11099 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11100 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11101 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011102 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011103
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011104 Arguments:
11105 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11106 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011107
11108 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011109 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11110
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011111 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11112 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011113
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011114 - set-src-port <expr> :
11115 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11116 expression.
11117
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011118 Arguments:
11119 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11120 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011121
11122 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011123 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11124
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011125 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11126 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11127 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011128
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011129 - set-dst <expr> :
11130 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11131 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11132 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11133 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11134 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11135
11136 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11137 followed by some converters.
11138
11139 Example:
11140
11141 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11142 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11143
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011144 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11145 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11146
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011147 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11148 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11149 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11150 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11151
11152
11153 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11154 followed by some converters.
11155
11156 Example:
11157
11158 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11159
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011160 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11161 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11162 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11163
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011164 - "silent-drop" :
11165 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011166 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011167 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11168 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11169 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11170 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11171 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011172 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11173 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011174 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11175 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011176 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011177 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11178 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11179 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11180 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11181
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011182 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11183 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11184 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011185
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011186 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11187 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11188 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011189
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011190 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011191 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011192 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011193
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011194 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11195 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11196 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011197
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011198 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011199 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11200 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011201
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011202 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11203
11204 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11205
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011206 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11207
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011208 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011209
11210
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011211tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11212 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011214 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011215 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011216 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11217 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011218
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011219 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011220
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011221 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011222 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11223 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11224 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11225 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011226
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011227 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11228 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11229 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11230 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011231 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11232 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11233 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11234 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11235 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11236 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011237 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011238 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011239
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011240 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11241 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11242 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11243 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011244
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011245 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011246 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011247 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011248 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11249 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011250 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011251 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011252 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011253 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011254 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011255 - set-dst <expr>
11256 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011257 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011258 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011259 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011260 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011261 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011262
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011263 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11264 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011265 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11266 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011267
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011268 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11269 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11270 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11271 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11272 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11273 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011274
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011275 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011276 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11277 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011278
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011279 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011280 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
11281 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
11282 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
11283 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011284 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
11285 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
11286 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011287
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011288 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011289 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11290 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11291 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011292
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011293 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11294 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11295
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011296 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011297 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11298 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011299
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011300 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11301 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011302 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011303 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11304 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011305 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011306 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011307 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011308 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11309 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011310 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011311 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11312 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011313
11314 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11315 followed by some converters.
11316
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011317 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11318 <var-name>.
11319
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011320 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11321 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11322 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11323 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11324 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11325
11326 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11327 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11328 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11329 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11330 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11331 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11332 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11333 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11334 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11335 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11336 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11337
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011338 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11339 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11340 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11341 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11342 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11343
11344 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11345
11346 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11347
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011348 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11349 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11350 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11351 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11352 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11353 evaluated.
11354
11355 Example:
11356 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11357
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011358 Example:
11359
11360 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011361 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011362
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011363 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011364 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11365 # and reject everything else.
11366 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11367 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011368 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011369 tcp-request content reject
11370
11371 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011372 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11373 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11374 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011375 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011376
11377 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11378 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11379 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011380 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011381 tcp-request content reject
11382
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011383 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011384 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011385 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011386 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011387 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11388 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011389
11390 Example:
11391 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11392 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011393 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011394
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011395 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011396 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011397
11398 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011399 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011400 # protecting all our sites
11401 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011402 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11403 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011404 ...
11405 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11406
11407 backend http_dynamic
11408 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011409 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011410 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011411 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011412 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011413 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011414 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011415
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011416 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011417
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011418 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11419 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011420
11421
11422tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11423 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011425 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011426 Arguments :
11427 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11428 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11429 as explained at the top of this document.
11430
11431 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11432 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11433 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11434 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11435 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11436
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011437 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11438 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11439 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11440 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11441
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011442 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11443 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011444 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011445 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011446 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11447 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11448 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11449 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011450
11451 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11452 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11453 it pass through unaffected.
11454
11455 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11456 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11457 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011458 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011459 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11460 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011461 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11462 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11463 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011464
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011465 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011466 "timeout client".
11467
11468
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011469tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11470 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11472 no | no | yes | yes
11473 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011474 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11475 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011476
11477 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11478
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011479 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011480 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11481 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011482 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11483 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011484
11485 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11486
11487 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11488 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11489 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11490 inserted.
11491
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011492 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011493 - accept :
11494 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11495 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11496 the rules evaluation.
11497
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011498 - close :
11499 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11500 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11501 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11502 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11503 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11504 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011505 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011506 protocols.
11507
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011508 - reject :
11509 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11510 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011511 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011512
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011513 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11514 Sets a variable.
11515
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011516 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11517 Unsets a variable.
11518
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011519 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11520 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11521 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11522 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11523
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011524 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11525 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11526 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11527 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11528
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011529 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11530 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11531 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11532 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11533 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011534
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011535 - "silent-drop" :
11536 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011537 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011538 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11539 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11540 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11541 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11542 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011543 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11544 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011545 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11546 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011547 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011548 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11549 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11550 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11551 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11552
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011553 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11554 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11555
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011556 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11557 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11558 for changing the default action to a reject.
11559
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011560 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11561 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11562 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11563 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011564 period.
11565
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011566 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11567 declared inline.
11568
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011569 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11570 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011571 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011572 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11573 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011574 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011575 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011576 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011577 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11578 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011579 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011580 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11581 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011582
11583 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11584 followed by some converters.
11585
11586 Example:
11587
11588 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11589
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011590 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11591 <var-name>.
11592
11593 Example:
11594
11595 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11596
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011597 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11598 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11599 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11600 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11601 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11602
11603 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11604
11605 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11606
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011607 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11608
11609 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11610
11611
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011612tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11613 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11615 no | yes | yes | no
11616 Arguments :
11617 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11618 below.
11619
11620 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11621
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011622 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011623 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11624 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11625 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11626 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11627 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11628 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11629 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011630 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011631 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11632 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11633 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11634 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11635 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11636 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11637 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11638 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11639 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11640 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11641 instead.
11642
11643 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11644 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11645 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11646 rules which may be inserted.
11647
11648 Several types of actions are supported :
11649 - accept : the request is accepted
11650 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11651 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11652 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011653 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011654 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011655 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011656 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011657 - silent-drop
11658
11659 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11660 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11661 sections for a complete description.
11662
11663 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11664 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11665 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11666
11667 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11668 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11669 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11670 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11671 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11672
11673 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11674 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11675
11676 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11677 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
11678 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
11679
11680 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11681 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
11682 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11683
11684 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
11685 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11686 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
11687
11688 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11689 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11690 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
11691
11692 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11693
11694 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
11695
11696
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011697tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
11698 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
11699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11700 no | no | yes | yes
11701 Arguments :
11702 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11703 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11704 as explained at the top of this document.
11705
11706 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
11707
11708
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011709timeout check <timeout>
11710 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
11711 established.
11712
11713 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11714 yes | no | yes | yes
11715 Arguments:
11716 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11717 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11718 as explained at the top of this document.
11719
11720 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
11721 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011722 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011723 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010011724 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
11725 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
11726 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011727
11728 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
11729 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
11730
11731 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
11732 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011733 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011734
11735 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11736 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11737 forget about it.
11738
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011739 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
11740 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011741
11742
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011743timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011744 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
11745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11746 yes | yes | yes | no
11747 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011748 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011749 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11750 as explained at the top of this document.
11751
11752 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11753 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11754 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010011755 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
11756 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
11757 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
11758 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011759 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
11760 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
11761 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011762 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011763 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011764 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
11765 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011766 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
11767 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011768
11769 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11770 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11771 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11772 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011773 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011774 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11775
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011776 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011777
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011778 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011779
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011780
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011781timeout client-fin <timeout>
11782 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
11783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11784 yes | yes | yes | no
11785 Arguments :
11786 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11787 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11788 as explained at the top of this document.
11789
11790 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11791 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11792 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11793 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11794 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
11795 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11796 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010011797 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
11798 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
11799 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011800
11801 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11802 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11803 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
11804
11805 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
11806
11807
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011808timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011809 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
11810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11811 yes | no | yes | yes
11812 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011813 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011814 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11815 as explained at the top of this document.
11816
11817 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011818 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011819 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011820 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011821 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
11822 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011823
11824 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11825 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11826 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11827 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011828 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011829 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11830
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011831 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011832
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011833
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011834timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
11835 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
11836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11837 yes | yes | yes | yes
11838 Arguments :
11839 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11840 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11841 as explained at the top of this document.
11842
11843 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
11844 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
11845 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
11846 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
11847 once the request has started to present itself.
11848
11849 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
11850 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
11851 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
11852 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
11853 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
11854
11855 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
11856 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
11857 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
11858 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
11859
11860 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
11861 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011862 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011863 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
11864 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011865 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011866
11867 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
11868 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
11869 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11870 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11871
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011872 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11873 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011874 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11875
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011876 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11877
11878
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011879timeout http-request <timeout>
11880 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011882 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011883 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011884 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011885 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11886 as explained at the top of this document.
11887
11888 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11889 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11890 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11891 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11892 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11893 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11894 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011895 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11896 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11897 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11898 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011899 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011900 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11901 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011902
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011903 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11904 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11905 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11906 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11907 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011908 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011909
11910 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11911 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011912 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011913 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11914 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11915
11916 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011917 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11918 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11919 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011920
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011921 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011922 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011923
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011924
11925timeout queue <timeout>
11926 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11928 yes | no | yes | yes
11929 Arguments :
11930 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11931 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11932 as explained at the top of this document.
11933
11934 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11935 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11936 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11937 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11938 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11939
11940 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11941 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11942 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11943 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11944
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011945 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011946
11947
11948timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011949 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11951 yes | no | yes | yes
11952 Arguments :
11953 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11954 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11955 as explained at the top of this document.
11956
11957 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11958 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11959 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11960 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11961 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11962 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11963 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11964
11965 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11966 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11967 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11968 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11969 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011970 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011971 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011972 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11973 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011974 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11975 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011976
11977 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11978 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11979 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11980 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011981 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011982 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11983
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011984 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011985
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011986
11987timeout server-fin <timeout>
11988 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11990 yes | no | yes | yes
11991 Arguments :
11992 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11993 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11994 as explained at the top of this document.
11995
11996 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11997 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11998 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11999 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12000 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12001 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12002 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12003 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12004 situations, it should not be needed.
12005
12006 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12007 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12008 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12009
12010 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12011
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012012
12013timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012014 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12016 yes | yes | yes | yes
12017 Arguments :
12018 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12019 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12020 as explained at the top of this document.
12021
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012022 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12023 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12024 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012025
12026 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12027 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12028 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12029 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012030 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012031
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012032 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012033
12034
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012035timeout tunnel <timeout>
12036 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12038 yes | no | yes | yes
12039 Arguments :
12040 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12041 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12042 as explained at the top of this document.
12043
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012044 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012045 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12046 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12047 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012048 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12049 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012050 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12051 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12052 specified.
12053
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012054 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12055 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12056 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12057 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12058 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12059 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12060 state.
12061
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012062 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12063 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12064 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12065 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012066 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012067
12068 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12069 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12070 forget about it.
12071
12072 Example :
12073 defaults http
12074 option http-server-close
12075 timeout connect 5s
12076 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012077 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012078 timeout server 30s
12079 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12080
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012081 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012082
12083
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012084transparent (deprecated)
12085 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012087 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012088 Arguments : none
12089
12090 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12091 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12092 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12093 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12094 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12095 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12096 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12097 appropriate server.
12098
12099 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12100
12101 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12102 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12103
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012104 See also: "option transparent"
12105
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012106unique-id-format <string>
12107 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12109 yes | yes | yes | no
12110 Arguments :
12111 <string> is a log-format string.
12112
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012113 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12114 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12115 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12116 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012117
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012118 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12119 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12120 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12121 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12122 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12123 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12124 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12125 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012126
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012127 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12128 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012129
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012130 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012131
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012132 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012133
12134 will generate:
12135
12136 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12137
12138 See also: "unique-id-header"
12139
12140unique-id-header <name>
12141 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12143 yes | yes | yes | no
12144 Arguments :
12145 <name> is the name of the header.
12146
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012147 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12148 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012149
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012150 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012151
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012152 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012153 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12154
12155 will generate:
12156
12157 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12158
12159 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012160
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012161use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012162 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12164 no | yes | yes | no
12165 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012166 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12167 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012168
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012169 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12170 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012171
12172 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12173 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12174 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012175 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012176 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012177 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12178 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012179
12180 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12181 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12182 assign the backend.
12183
12184 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12185 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12186 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12187 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12188 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12189 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12190
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012191 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012192 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012193 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12194 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12195 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12196
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012197 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12198 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12199 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12200 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12201 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12202 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12203 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12204 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12205 cannot be forced from the request.
12206
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012207 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012208 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12209 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12210
12211 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12212 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012213
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012214use-fcgi-app <name>
12215 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12217 no | no | yes | yes
12218 Arguments :
12219 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12220
12221 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012222
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012223use-server <server> if <condition>
12224use-server <server> unless <condition>
12225 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12227 no | no | yes | yes
12228 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012229 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12230 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012231
12232 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12233
12234 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12235 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12236 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12237
12238 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12239 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12240 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12241 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12242 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12243 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12244 matches will assign the server.
12245
12246 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12247 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12248 with the next rules until one matches.
12249
12250 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12251 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12252 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12253 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12254
12255 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12256 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12257 stripped.
12258
12259 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12260 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012261 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12262 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12263 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012264
12265 Example :
12266 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12267 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12268 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12269 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012270 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012271 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012272 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012273 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12274 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12275
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012276 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12277 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12278 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12279 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012280 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012281 and we fall back to load balancing.
12282
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012283 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012284
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012285
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100122865. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012287--------------------------
12288
12289The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12290depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12291settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12292written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12293described in this section.
12294
12295
122965.1. Bind options
12297-----------------
12298
12299The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12300as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12301no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12302parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12303while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12304provided immediately after the setting name.
12305
12306The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12307
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012308accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12309 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12310 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12311 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12312 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12313 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12314 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12315 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12316 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12317 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012318 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12319 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12320 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012321
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012322accept-proxy
12323 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012324 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12325 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012326 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12327 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12328 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12329 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012330 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012331 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12332 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012333 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12334 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012335
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012336allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012337 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012338 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012339 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012340 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12341 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012342
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012343alpn <protocols>
12344 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12345 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12346 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012347 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012348 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012349 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12350 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12351 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12352 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12353 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12354 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12355 preference, like below :
12356
12357 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012358
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012359backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012360 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012361 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12362
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012363curves <curves>
12364 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12365 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12366 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12367 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12368 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12369 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12370
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012371ecdhe <named curve>
12372 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012373 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12374 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012375
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012376ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012377 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12378 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12379 client's certificate.
12380
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012381ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12382 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12383 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12384 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12385 error is ignored.
12386
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012387ca-sign-file <cafile>
12388 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12389 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12390 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12391 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12392 'generate-certificates' for details.
12393
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012394ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012395 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12396 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12397 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12398 'generate-certificates' for details.
12399
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012400ca-verify-file <cafile>
12401 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12402 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12403 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12404 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12405 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12406
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012407ciphers <ciphers>
12408 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12409 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012410 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012411 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012412 information and recommendations see e.g.
12413 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12414 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12415 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12416
12417ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12418 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12419 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12420 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12421 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012422 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12423 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012424
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012425crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012426 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12427 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12428 to verify client's certificate.
12429
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012430crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012431 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12432 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12433 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12434 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12435 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012436 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12437 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012438
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012439 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12440 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12441
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012442 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12443 are loaded.
12444
12445 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012446 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12447 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12448 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12449 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12450 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12451 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12452 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012453 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012454
12455 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12456 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12457 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12458 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012459 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12460 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012461
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012462 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012463
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012464 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012465 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012466 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12467 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012468 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12469 clients).
12470
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012471 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12472 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12473 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12474 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12475 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12476 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12477 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12478 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12479 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12480 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12481 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12482 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12483 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12484
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012485 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12486 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12487 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12488 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12489 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12490
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012491 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12492 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12493 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12494 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012495
12496 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
12497 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
12498 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
12499 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
12500 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
12501 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
12502 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
12503 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
12504 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
12505
12506 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
12507
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012508 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012509 a cert bundle.
12510
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012511 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012512 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
12513 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
12514 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
12515 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
12516 provide multi-cert support.
12517
12518 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
12519
12520 Filename | CN | SAN
12521 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12522 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012523 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012524 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
12525 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12526
12527 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
12528 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
12529 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
12530 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012531 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
12532 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
12533 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012534
12535 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
12536 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
12537
12538 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
12539 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
12540 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
12541
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012542crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012543 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012544 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012545 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012546 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012547
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012548crt-list <file>
12549 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012550 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12551 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012552
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012553 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12554
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012555 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12556 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12557 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12558 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12559 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012560
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012561 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
12562 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
12563 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
12564 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
12565 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
12566 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12567 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12568 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012569
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012570 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020012571 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012572 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
12573 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
12574 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012575
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012576 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12577
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012578 crt-list file example:
12579 cert1.pem
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012580 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012581 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012582 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012583 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012584
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012585defer-accept
12586 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12587 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12588 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012589 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012590 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12591 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12592 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12593 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12594 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12595 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12596 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12597
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012598expose-fd listeners
12599 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12600 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012601 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12602 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012603 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012604
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012605force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012606 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012607 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012608 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012609 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012610
12611force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012612 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012613 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012614 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012615
12616force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012617 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012618 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012619 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012620
12621force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012622 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012623 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012624 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012625
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012626force-tlsv13
12627 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12628 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012629 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012630
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012631generate-certificates
12632 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12633 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12634 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12635 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12636 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12637 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12638 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12639 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12640 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12641 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12642 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12643
12644 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12645 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012646 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012647 certificate is used many times.
12648
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012649gid <gid>
12650 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12651 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12652 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12653 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12654 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12655
12656group <group>
12657 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12658 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12659 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12660 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12661 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12662
12663id <id>
12664 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12665 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12666 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12667 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12668
12669interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012670 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12671 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12672 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12673 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12674 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12675 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012676 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12677 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12678 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12679 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12680 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12681 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012682
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012683level <level>
12684 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12685 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12686 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012687 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012688 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12689 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12690 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012691 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012692 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012693 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012694 all counters).
12695
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012696severity-output <format>
12697 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12698 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12699 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12700 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12701 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12702 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12703 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12704 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12705 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12706 rfc5424 convention.
12707
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012708maxconn <maxconn>
12709 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12710 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12711 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
12712 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
12713 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
12714 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
12715 eat all memory.
12716
12717mode <mode>
12718 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
12719 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
12720 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
12721 UNIX sockets.
12722
12723mss <maxseg>
12724 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
12725 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
12726 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
12727 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
12728 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
12729 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
12730 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
12731 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
12732 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
12733 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
12734 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
12735
12736name <name>
12737 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
12738 page.
12739
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012740namespace <name>
12741 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12742 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
12743 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12744 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12745
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012746nice <nice>
12747 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
12748 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
12749 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
12750 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
12751 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
12752 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
12753 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
12754 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
12755 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
12756 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
12757 one for an RDP socket.
12758
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012759no-ca-names
12760 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12761 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012762 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012763
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012764no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012765 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012766 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012767 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012768 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012769 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
12770 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012771
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012772no-tls-tickets
12773 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12774 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12775 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012776 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
12777 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012778 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12779 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12780 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012781
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012782no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012783 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012784 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012785 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012786 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012787 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12788 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012789
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012790no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012791 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012792 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012793 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012794 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012795 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12796 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012797
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012798no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012799 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012800 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012801 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012802 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012803 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12804 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012805
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012806no-tlsv13
12807 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12808 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
12809 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
12810 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012811 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12812 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012813
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012814npn <protocols>
12815 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12816 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12817 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012818 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012819 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012820 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12821 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
12822 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
12823 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
12824 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012825
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012826prefer-client-ciphers
12827 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
12828 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
12829 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020012830 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
12831 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
12832 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012833
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012834process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012835 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012836 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012837 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012838 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
12839 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
12840 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
12841 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012842 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012843 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
12844 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
12845 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
12846 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
12847 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012848
12849 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
12850
12851 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
12852 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
12853 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
12854 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
12855 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
12856 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
12857 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
12858 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020012859
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012860proto <name>
12861 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
12862 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
12863 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
12864 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040012865 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012866 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080012867 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012868 h2" on the bind line.
12869
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012870ssl
12871 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012872 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012873 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
12874 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012875 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12876 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012877
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012878ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12879 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012880 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
12881 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
12882 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012883 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12884
12885ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012886 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
12887 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
12888 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
12889 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012890
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012891strict-sni
12892 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12893 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12894 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12895 See the "crt" option for more information.
12896
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012897tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012898 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012899 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12900 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012901 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012902 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12903 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12904 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12905 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12906 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12907 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12908 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12909
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012910tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012911 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012912 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12913 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12914 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12915 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12916 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12917 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12918 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012919 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12920 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12921 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012922
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012923tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12924 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012925 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12926 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12927 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12928 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12929 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12930 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12931 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12932 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12933 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12934 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012935 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12936 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12937
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012938transparent
12939 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12940 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12941 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12942 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12943 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12944 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12945 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12946 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12947 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12948 so check for support with your vendor.
12949
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012950v4v6
12951 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12952 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12953 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12954 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012955 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012956
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012957v6only
12958 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12959 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12960 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012961 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12962 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012963
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012964uid <uid>
12965 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12966 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12967 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12968 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12969 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12970
12971user <user>
12972 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12973 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12974 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12975 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12976 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12977
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012978verify [none|optional|required]
12979 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12980 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12981 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12982 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12983 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012984 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12985 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12986 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12987 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012988
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200129895.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012990------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012991
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012992The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12993which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12994arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12995settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12996after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12997Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12998address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012999
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013000 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013001 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013002
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013003Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13004keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13005
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013006The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013007
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013008addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013009 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013010 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13011 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13012 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13013 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13014 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013015
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013016agent-check
13017 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013018 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013019 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13020 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13021 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013022
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013023 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013024 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013025 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13026 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13027 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013028
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013029 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13030 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13031 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13032 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13033 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013034
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013035 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013036 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013037
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013038 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13039 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13040 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013041
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013042 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13043 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13044 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013045
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013046 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
13047 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13048 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13049 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13050 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013051 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013052 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013053
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013054 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13055 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013056
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013057 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13058 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13059 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13060 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13061 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13062 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13063 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13064 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13065 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013066
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013067 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13068 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013069 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13070 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13071 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013072 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013073
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013074 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013075 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013076
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013077agent-send <string>
13078 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13079 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13080 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13081 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13082 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13083
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013084agent-inter <delay>
13085 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13086 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13087
13088 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13089 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13090 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13091 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13092 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13093 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13094 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13095 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13096 of backends use the same servers.
13097
13098 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13099
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013100agent-addr <addr>
13101 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13102
13103 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13104 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13105 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13106 hostname, it will be resolved.
13107
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013108agent-port <port>
13109 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13110
13111 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13112
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013113allow-0rtt
13114 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013115 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13116 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013117
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013118alpn <protocols>
13119 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13120 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13121 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013122 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013123 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13124 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13125 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13126 now obsolete NPN extension.
13127 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13128 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13129
13130 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13131
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013132backup
13133 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13134 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13135 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13136 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013137 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13138 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013139
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013140ca-file <cafile>
13141 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13142 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13143 server's certificate.
13144
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013145check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013146 This option enables health checks on a server:
13147 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13148 considered available.
13149 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13150 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13151 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13152 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13153 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13154 set.
13155 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13156 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13157 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13158 exchanges succeed.
13159
13160 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13161 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13162 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13163 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13164 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013165 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013166 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13167
13168 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13169 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13170
13171 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13172 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13173
13174 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13175 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13176 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13177 available.
13178
13179 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13180 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13181 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13182
13183 Example:
13184 # simple tcp check
13185 backend foo
13186 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13187 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13188 backend foo
13189 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13190 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13191 backend foo
13192 option tcp-check
13193 tcp-check connect
13194 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013195
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013196check-send-proxy
13197 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13198 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13199 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13200 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13201 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13202 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13203 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13204
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013205check-alpn <protocols>
13206 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13207 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13208 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13209
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013210check-proto <name>
13211 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13212 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13213 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13214 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013215 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013216 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13217 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13218
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013219check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013220 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013221 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13222 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013223
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013224check-ssl
13225 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13226 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13227 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13228 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013229 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013230 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13231 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013232 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013233 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13234 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013235
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013236check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013237 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013238 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13239 for normal traffic.
13240
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013241ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013242 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13243 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13244 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013245 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13246 information and recommendations see e.g.
13247 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13248 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13249 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013250
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013251ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13252 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13253 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13254 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13255 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013256 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13257 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13258 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013260cookie <value>
13261 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13262 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13263 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13264 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13265 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13266 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13267 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13268
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013269crl-file <crlfile>
13270 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13271 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13272 to verify server's certificate.
13273
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013274crt <cert>
13275 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13276 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13277 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13278 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13279 certificate request.
13280
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013281disabled
13282 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13283 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13284 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13285 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13286 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013287 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013288
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013289enabled
13290 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13291 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13292 default value.
13293 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13294 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013295
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013296error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013297 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13298 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13299 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013300
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013301 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013302
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013303fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013304 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13305 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13306 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13307
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013308force-sslv3
13309 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13310 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013311 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013312 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013313
13314force-tlsv10
13315 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013316 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013317 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013318
13319force-tlsv11
13320 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013321 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013322 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013323
13324force-tlsv12
13325 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013326 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013327 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013328
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013329force-tlsv13
13330 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13331 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013332 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013333
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013334id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013335 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13336 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13337 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013338
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013339init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13340 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13341 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013342 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013343 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13344 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13345 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13346 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13347 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13348 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13349 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13350 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13351 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013352 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013353 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13354 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13355 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13356 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13357 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13358 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013359 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013360
13361 Example:
13362 defaults
13363 # never fail on address resolution
13364 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13365
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013366inter <delay>
13367fastinter <delay>
13368downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013369 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13370 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13371 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13372 between checks depending on the server state :
13373
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013374 Server state | Interval used
13375 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13376 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13377 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13378 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13379 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13380 or yet unchecked. |
13381 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13382 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13383 | "inter" otherwise.
13384 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013385
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013386 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13387 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13388 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13389 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013390 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13391 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13392 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13393 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13394 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013395
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013396log-proto <logproto>
13397 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13398 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13399 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13400 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13401
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013402maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013403 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13404 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013405 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13406 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013407 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13408 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13409 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13410 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13411
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013412 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13413 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13414 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13415 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13416 than 50 concurrent requests.
13417
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013418maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013419 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13420 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13421 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13422 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
13423 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
13424 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
13425 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
13426
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013427max-reuse <count>
13428 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13429 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13430 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13431 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13432 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13433 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13434 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13435 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13436
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013437minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013438 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13439 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13440 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13441 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13442 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13443 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013444 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013445 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013446
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013447namespace <name>
13448 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13449 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13450 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13451 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13452
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013453no-agent-check
13454 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13455 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13456 default value.
13457 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13458 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13459
13460no-backup
13461 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13462 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13463 default value.
13464 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13465 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13466
13467no-check
13468 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13469 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13470 default value.
13471 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13472 "default-server" "check" setting.
13473
13474no-check-ssl
13475 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13476 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13477 default value.
13478 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13479 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13480
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013481no-send-proxy
13482 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13483 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13484 default value.
13485 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13486 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13487
13488no-send-proxy-v2
13489 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13490 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13491 default value.
13492 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13493 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13494
13495no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13496 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13497 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13498 default value.
13499 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13500 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13501
13502no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13503 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13504 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13505 default value.
13506 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13507 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13508
13509no-ssl
13510 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13511 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13512 default value.
13513 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13514 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13515
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013516no-ssl-reuse
13517 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13518 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13519 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13520 and for paranoid users.
13521
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013522no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013523 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13524 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013525 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013526
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013527 Supported in default-server: No
13528
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013529no-tls-tickets
13530 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13531 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13532 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013533 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13534 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013535 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13536 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13537 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013538 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013539
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013540no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013541 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013542 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13543 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013544 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13545 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013546 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013547
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013548 Supported in default-server: No
13549
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013550no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013551 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013552 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13553 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013554 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13555 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013556 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013557
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013558 Supported in default-server: No
13559
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013560no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013561 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013562 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13563 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013564 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13565 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013566 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013567
13568 Supported in default-server: No
13569
13570no-tlsv13
13571 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13572 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13573 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13574 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13575 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013576 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013577
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013578 Supported in default-server: No
13579
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013580no-verifyhost
13581 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13582 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13583 default value.
13584 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13585 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013586
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013587no-tfo
13588 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13589 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13590 default value.
13591 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13592 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13593
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013594non-stick
13595 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13596 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13597 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13598
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013599npn <protocols>
13600 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13601 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13602 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013603 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013604 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13605 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13606 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13607
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013608observe <mode>
13609 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13610 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13611 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13612 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13613 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13614 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013615 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013616
13617 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13618
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013619on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013620 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13621 Currently, four modes are available:
13622 - fastinter: force fastinter
13623 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13624 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13625 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13626 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13627
13628 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13629
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013630on-marked-down <action>
13631 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13632 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013633 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13634 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13635 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13636 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13637 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13638 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13639 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13640 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013641
13642 Actions are disabled by default
13643
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013644on-marked-up <action>
13645 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13646 Currently one action is available:
13647 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13648 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13649 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13650 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013651 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13652 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013653 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13654 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13655
13656 Actions are disabled by default
13657
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020013658pool-low-conn <max>
13659 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
13660 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
13661 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
13662 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
13663 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
13664 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
13665 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
13666 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
13667 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
13668 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
13669 applying to "http-reuse".
13670
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013671pool-max-conn <max>
13672 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13673 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13674 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13675 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13676 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13677 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13678
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013679pool-purge-delay <delay>
13680 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013681 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013682 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013683
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013684port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013685 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13686 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13687 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13688 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13689 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13690 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13691
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013692proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013693 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13694 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13695 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13696 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013697 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013698 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13699
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013700redir <prefix>
13701 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
13702 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
13703 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
13704 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
13705 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
13706 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
13707 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
13708 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013709 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013710 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013711 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
13712 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
13713 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
13714 loop between the client and HAProxy!
13715
13716 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
13717
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013718rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013719 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
13720 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
13721 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
13722
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013723resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
13724 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
13725 server.
13726
13727 Available options:
13728
13729 * allow-dup-ip
13730 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
13731 resolution at runtime is in operation.
13732 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
13733 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
13734 For such case, simply enable this option.
13735 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
13736
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050013737 * ignore-weight
13738 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
13739 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
13740 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
13741
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013742 * prevent-dup-ip
13743 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
13744 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
13745 same fqdn.
13746 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
13747
13748 Example:
13749 backend b_myapp
13750 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
13751 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13752 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13753
13754 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
13755 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
13756 it
13757 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
13758 different address
13759
13760 Default value: not set
13761
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013762resolve-prefer <family>
13763 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
13764 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
13765 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
13766 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
13767
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020013768 Default value: ipv6
13769
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013770 Example:
13771
13772 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013773
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013774resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013775 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013776 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013777 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013778 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
13779 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013780 configured network, another address is selected.
13781
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013782 Example:
13783
13784 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013785
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013786resolvers <id>
13787 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
13788 hostname.
13789
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013790 Example:
13791
13792 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013793
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013794 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013795
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013796send-proxy
13797 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
13798 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
13799 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
13800 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013801 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
13802 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
13803 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
13804 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
13805 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
13806 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
13807 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
13808 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
13809 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
13810 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013811 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
13812 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013813
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013814send-proxy-v2
13815 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
13816 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13817 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13818 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020013819 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
13820 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
13821 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
13822 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013823
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013824proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010013825 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
13826 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
13827
13828 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
13829 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
13830 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
13831 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
13832 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
13833 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
13834 connection is supported).
13835 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
13836 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
13837 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
13838 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
13839 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
13840 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
13841 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013842
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013843send-proxy-v2-ssl
13844 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13845 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13846 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13847 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13848 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13849 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
13850 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013851 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
13852 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013853
13854send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13855 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13856 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13857 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13858 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13859 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13860 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
13861 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
13862 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013863 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
13864 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013865
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013866slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013867 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
13868 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
13869 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
13870 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
13871 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
13872 parameters :
13873
13874 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
13875 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
13876
13877 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
13878 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
13879 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
13880 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
13881
13882 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
13883 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
13884 seen as failed.
13885
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013886sni <expression>
13887 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
13888 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
13889 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
13890 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020013891 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
13892 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013893 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010013894 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
13895 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013896
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013897source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020013898source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013899source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013900 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
13901 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
13902 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
13903 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
13904
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013905 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
13906 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
13907 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
13908 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
13909 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
13910 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
13911 server.
13912
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000013913 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
13914 specifying the source address without port(s).
13915
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013916ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020013917 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
13918 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
13919 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
13920 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
13921 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
13922 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013923 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
13924 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013925
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013926ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13927 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
13928 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13929 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13930
13931ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13932 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
13933 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13934 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
13935
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013936ssl-reuse
13937 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
13938 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13939 default value.
13940 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13941 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
13942
13943stick
13944 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
13945 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13946 default value.
13947 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13948 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013949
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013950socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013951 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013952 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
13953 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
13954
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013955tcp-ut <delay>
13956 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
13957 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
13958 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013959 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013960 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
13961 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
13962 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
13963 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
13964 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
13965 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
13966 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
13967 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
13968 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13969
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013970tfo
13971 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
13972 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
13973 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
13974 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
13975 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013976 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013977
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013978track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020013979 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
13980 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
13981 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
13982 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013983 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
13984
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013985tls-tickets
13986 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
13987 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13988 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013989 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13990 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13991 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013992 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010013993 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013994
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013995verify [none|required]
13996 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010013997 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013998 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
13999 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014000 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014001 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14002 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14003 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14004 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14005 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14006 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14007 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14008 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014009
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014010verifyhost <hostname>
14011 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014012 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14013 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14014 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14015 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14016 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14017 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14018 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14019 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014020
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014021weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014022 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14023 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14024 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014025 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14026 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14027 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14028 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14029 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14030 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014031
14032
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200140335.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14034-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014035
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014036HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14037using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
14038configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014039This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14040can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14041workload.
14042This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14043resolution at run time.
14044Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14045carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14046
14047
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200140485.3.1. Global overview
14049----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014050
14051As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14052different steps of the process life:
14053
14054 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14055 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14056 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14057
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014058 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14059 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014060
14061A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14062 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14063 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14064 resolution to know this new IP.
14065
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014066When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014067HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014068SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14069from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14070will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14071will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014072
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014073A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014074 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014075 first valid response.
14076
14077 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14078 servers return an error.
14079
14080
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200140815.3.2. The resolvers section
14082----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014083
14084This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014085HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14086contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014087
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014088When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14089uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14090is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14091answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14092
14093When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014094used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014095
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014096 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14097 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14098 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014099
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014100 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14101 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014102
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014103 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14104 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14105 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014106
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014107For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14108following scenarios are possible:
14109
14110 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14111 ignored
14112
14113 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14114 applied
14115
14116 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14117 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14118
14119 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14120 retries the query with a new type
14121
14122 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14123 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014124
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014125As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14126a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014127<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014128
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014129
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014130resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014131 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014132
14133A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14134
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014135accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014136 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014137 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014138 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14139 by RFC 6891)
14140
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014141 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
14142
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014143nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
14144 DNS server description:
14145 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
14146 <ip> : IP address of the server
14147 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
14148
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014149parse-resolv-conf
14150 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14151 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14152 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14153
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014154hold <status> <period>
14155 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14156 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014157 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014158 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014159 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14160 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14161 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14162
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014163 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014164
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014165resolve_retries <nb>
14166 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14167 giving up.
14168 Default value: 3
14169
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014170 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14171 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14172 type.
14173
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014174timeout <event> <time>
14175 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14176 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14177 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014178 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14179 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014180 Default value: 1s
14181 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014182 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014183 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014184 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14185 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14186
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014187 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014188
14189 resolvers mydns
14190 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14191 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014192 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014193 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014194 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014195 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014196 hold other 30s
14197 hold refused 30s
14198 hold nx 30s
14199 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014200 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014201 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014202
14203
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200142046. Cache
14205---------
14206
14207HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14208(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14209RAM.
14210
14211The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14212this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14213
14214If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14215independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14216when we try to allocate a new one.
14217
14218The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14219
14220It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14221"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14222for more details.
14223
14224When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14225replaced by "<CACHE>".
14226
14227
142286.1. Limitation
14229----------------
14230
14231The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14232
14233- If the response is not a 200
14234- If the response contains a Vary header
14235- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14236- If the response is not cacheable
14237
14238- If the request is not a GET
14239- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14240- If the request contains an Authorization header
14241
14242
142436.2. Setup
14244-----------
14245
14246To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14247the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14248
14249
142506.2.1. Cache section
14251---------------------
14252
14253cache <name>
14254 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14255 size of cache is mandatory.
14256
14257total-max-size <megabytes>
14258 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14259 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14260
14261max-object-size <bytes>
14262 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14263 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14264 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14265
14266max-age <seconds>
14267 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
14268 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14269 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14270 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14271 default.
14272
14273
142746.2.2. Proxy section
14275---------------------
14276
14277http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14278 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14279 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14280 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14281 after this one.
14282
14283http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14284 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14285 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14286 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14287 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14288
14289
14290Example:
14291
14292 backend bck1
14293 mode http
14294
14295 http-request cache-use foobar
14296 http-response cache-store foobar
14297 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14298
14299 cache foobar
14300 total-max-size 4
14301 max-age 240
14302
14303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143047. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14305----------------------------------
14306
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014307HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014308client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14309The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14310these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14311but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14312data called patterns.
14313
14314
143157.1. ACL basics
14316---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014317
14318The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14319content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14320from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14321simple :
14322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014323 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014324 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014325 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14326 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014328The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14329adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014330
14331In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014333 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014334
14335This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14336Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14337and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014338an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14339conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14340as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14341are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014342
14343ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14344'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14345which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14346
14347There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14348performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014350The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14351specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14352this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014353methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14354ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014355
14356Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14357 - boolean
14358 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14359 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14360 - string
14361 - data block
14362
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014363Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14364converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14365would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14366The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14367which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14368
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014369Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14370keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14371fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14372which are summarized in the table below :
14373
14374 +---------------------+-----------------+
14375 | Sample or converter | Default |
14376 | output type | matching method |
14377 +---------------------+-----------------+
14378 | boolean | bool |
14379 +---------------------+-----------------+
14380 | integer | int |
14381 +---------------------+-----------------+
14382 | ip | ip |
14383 +---------------------+-----------------+
14384 | string | str |
14385 +---------------------+-----------------+
14386 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14387 +---------------------+-----------------+
14388
14389Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14390matching method, see below.
14391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014392The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14393 - boolean
14394 - integer or integer range
14395 - IP address / network
14396 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14397 - regular expression
14398 - hex block
14399
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014400The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14401
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014402 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14403 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014404 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014405 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014406 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014407 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014408 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014410The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14411read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14412if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14413lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14414will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14415beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14416a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14417lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14418exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14419
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014420The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14421parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14422ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14423a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14424check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14425
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014426The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14427socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14428file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014430Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14431loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14432
14433 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14434
14435In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14436the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14437case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14438as well.
14439
14440The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14441sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14442do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14443methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14444is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014445obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014446followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14447default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14448that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14449string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14450
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014451The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14452By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14453string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14454resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14455server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014456waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014457flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14458function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014460There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14461sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14462be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014463
14464 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14465 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014466 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14467 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14468 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14469 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014470
14471 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14472 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014473 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014474
14475 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014476 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014477
14478 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014479 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014480
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014481 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014482 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14483
14484 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14485 binary or string samples.
14486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014487 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14488 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014490 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14491 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14492 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014494 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14495 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014497 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14498 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014500 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14501 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014503 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14504 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014505 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014507 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14508 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14509 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014510
14511For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14512request, it is possible to do :
14513
14514 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14515
14516In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14517buffer, one would use the following acl :
14518
14519 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14520
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014521On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14522possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14523
14524 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014526All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14527criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14528method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14529to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14530criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14531the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014533If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014534the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14535For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014537 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14538 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14539 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14540 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014541
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014542
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014543The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14544types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14545combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14546brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14547default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014549 +-------------------------------------------------+
14550 | Input sample type |
14551 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014552 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014553 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14554 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14555 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014556 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014557 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014558 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014559 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014560 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014561 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014562 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014563 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014564 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014565 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014566 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014567 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014568 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014569 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014570 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014571 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014572 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014573 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014574 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014575 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014576 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014577 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14578 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14579 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014580
14581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200145827.1.1. Matching booleans
14583------------------------
14584
14585In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14586Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14587When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14588that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14589
14590Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14591return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14592"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14593
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200145957.1.2. Matching integers
14596------------------------
14597
14598Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14599enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14600to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14601
14602Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14603matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14604lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014605
14606For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14607unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14608representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14609
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014610As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14611two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14612instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14613ranges and operators.
14614
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014615For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014616operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14617Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14618of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014619
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014620Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014621
14622 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14623 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14624 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14625 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14626 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14627
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014628For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014629
14630 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14631
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014632This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14633
14634 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14635
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146377.1.3. Matching strings
14638-----------------------
14639
14640String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14641different forms :
14642
14643 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014644 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014645
14646 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014647 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014648
14649 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14650 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14651
14652 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14653 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14654
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014655 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014656 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14657 matches.
14658
14659 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14660 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14661 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014662
14663String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14664exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14665characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14666string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14667to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014668before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014669
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014670Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14671(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14672Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14673
14674Example:
14675 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14676 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14677
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146797.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14680---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014681
14682Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14683they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14684possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14685passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14686the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014687the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14688match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014689
14690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146917.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
14692-------------------------------------
14693
14694It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
14695not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
14696a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
14697to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
14698digits may be used upper or lower case.
14699
14700Example :
14701 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
14702 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
14703
14704
147057.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
14706---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014707
14708IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
14709netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
14710within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014711host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014712difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
14713at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
14714does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
14715parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014716
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020014717The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
14718abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
14719
14720 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14721 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
14722 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14723 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
14724 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
14725 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
14726 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
14727 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14728
14729Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
14730192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
14731
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014732IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
14733Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
14734trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
14735IPv6 patterns.
14736
14737HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
14738following situations :
14739 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
14740 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
14741 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
14742 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
14743 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
14744 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
14745 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
14746 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
14747 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
14748 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
14749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014750
147517.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
14752----------------------------------
14753
14754Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
14755combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
14756
14757 - AND (implicit)
14758 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
14759 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014761A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014763 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014765Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
14766indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014768For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
14769"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
14770requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
14771is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
14772
14773 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014774 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
14775 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
14776 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014777
14778To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
14779and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
14780
14781 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
14782 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
14783 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
14784 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
14785
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014786 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014787 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
14788 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
14789 use_backend www if host_www
14790
14791It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
14792expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
14793be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
14794the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
14795
14796 The following rule :
14797
14798 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014799 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014800
14801 Can also be written that way :
14802
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014803 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014804
14805It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
14806to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
14807simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
14808sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
14809good use is the following :
14810
14811 With named ACLs :
14812
14813 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
14814 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
14815 monitor fail if site_dead
14816
14817 With anonymous ACLs :
14818
14819 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
14820
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014821See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
14822keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014823
14824
148257.3. Fetching samples
14826---------------------
14827
14828Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
14829against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
14830sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
14831ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
14832of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
14833available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
14834
14835This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
14836Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
14837compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
14838deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
14839
14840The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
14841matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
14842method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
14843indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
14844
14845As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
14846when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
14847mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
14848the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
14849ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
14850
14851Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
14852multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
14853when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014854incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
14855are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014856is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
14857all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
14858
14859Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
14860 - name
14861 - name(arg1)
14862 - name(arg1,arg2)
14863
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014864
148657.3.1. Converters
14866-----------------
14867
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014868Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
14869of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
14870is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
14871was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014872has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014873unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
14874
14875These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
14876sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
14877the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014878support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014879
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014880A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
14881support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
14882supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
14883(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
14884bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
14885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014886The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014887
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001488851d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
14889 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14890 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14891 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
14892 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14893 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14894
14895 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014896 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
14897 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000014898 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
14899 frontend http-in
14900 bind *:8081
14901 default_backend servers
14902 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14903 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14904
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014905add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014906 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014907 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014908 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
14909 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014910 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014911 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14912 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14913 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14914 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014915 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014916 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014917
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010014918aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
14919 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
14920 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
14921 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
14922 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
14923 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
14924 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
14925
14926 Example:
14927 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
14928 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
14929
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014930and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014931 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014932 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014933 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14934 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014935 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014936 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14937 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14938 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14939 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014940 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014941 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014942
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020014943b64dec
14944 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
14945 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
14946
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014947base64
14948 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014949 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014950 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
14951
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014952bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014953 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014954 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014955 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014956 presence of a flag).
14957
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014958bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
14959 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
14960 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014961 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014962
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014963concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
14964 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
14965 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
14966 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
14967 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
14968 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
14969 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
14970 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
14971 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
14972 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
14973 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014974 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014975 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014976 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
14977 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014978
14979 Example:
14980 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
14981 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
14982 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014983 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014984 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
14985
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014986cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014987 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
14988 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014989
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014990crc32([<avalanche>])
14991 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
14992 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14993 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14994 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14995 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14996 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
14997 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
14998 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
14999 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15000 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015001 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15002
15003crc32c([<avalanche>])
15004 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15005 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15006 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15007 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15008 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15009 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15010 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15011 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015012
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015013cut_crlf
15014 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15015 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15016 updated.
15017
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015018da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015019 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15020 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15021 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15022 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015023 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015024 configuration language.
15025
15026 Example:
15027 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015028 bind *:8881
15029 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015030 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015031
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015032debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15033 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15034 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15035 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15036 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15037 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15038 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15039 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15040 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15041 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15042 printable sample types.
15043
15044 Example:
15045 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015046
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015047digest(<algorithm>)
15048 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15049 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15050
15051 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15052 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15053
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015054div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015055 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15056 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015057 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015058 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15059 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015060 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015061 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15062 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15063 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15064 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015065 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015066 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015067
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015068djb2([<avalanche>])
15069 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15070 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15071 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15072 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15073 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15074 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15075 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015076 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15077 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015078
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015079even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015080 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015081 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15082
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015083field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15084 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15085 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15086 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15087 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15088 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15089 fields.
15090
15091 Example :
15092 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15093 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15094 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15095 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15096 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015097
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015098hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015099 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015100 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015101 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015102 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015103
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015104hex2i
15105 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015106 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015107
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015108htonl
15109 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15110 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15111 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15112 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15113
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015114hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
15115 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15116 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15117 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15118 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15119
15120 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15121 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15122
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015123http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015124 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15125 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015126 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15127 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15128 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15129 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15130 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15131 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15132 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15133 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015134
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015135in_table(<table>)
15136 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15137 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15138 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015139 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015140 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15141
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015142ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
15143 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015144 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015145 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15146 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15147 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15148 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15149 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015150
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015151json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015152 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015153 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015154 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015155 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15156 of errors:
15157 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15158 bytes, ...)
15159 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15160 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15161
15162 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15163 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15164 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15165 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15166 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15167 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015168 - "ascii" : never fails;
15169 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15170 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015171 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015172 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015173 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15174 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15175
15176 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015177 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015178
15179 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015180 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015181 capture request header user-agent len 150
15182 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015183
15184 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15185 GET / HTTP/1.0
15186 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15187
15188 Output log:
15189 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15190
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015191language(<value>[,<default>])
15192 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
15193 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
15194 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
15195 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
15196 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
15197 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
15198 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
15199 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
15200 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015201 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015202 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
15203 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015204
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015205 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015206
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015207 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15208 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015209
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015210 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15211 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15212 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15213 use_backend spanish if es
15214 use_backend french if fr
15215 use_backend english if en
15216 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015217
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015218length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015219 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15220 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15221 type. The result is of type integer.
15222
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015223lower
15224 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15225 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15226 type. The result is of type string.
15227
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015228ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15229 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15230 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15231 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15232 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15233 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15234 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15235
15236 Example :
15237
15238 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015239 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015240 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15241
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015242ltrim(<chars>)
15243 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15244 representation of the input sample.
15245
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015246map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15247map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15248map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15249 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15250 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15251 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15252 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15253 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15254 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15255 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15256 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015257
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015258 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15259 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15260 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015261
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015262 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015263 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015264
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015265 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15266 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15267 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15268 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015269 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15270 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015271 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15272 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15273 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15274 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15275 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15276 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15277 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15278 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015279 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15280 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15281 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015282 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15283 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15284 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15285 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15286 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015287
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015288 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15289 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15290 the corresponding match text.
15291
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015292 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15293 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15294 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15295 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15296 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015297
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015298 Example :
15299
15300 # this is a comment and is ignored
15301 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15302 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15303 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15304 | | | `---------- value
15305 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15306 | `---------------------------- key
15307 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15308
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015309mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015310 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15311 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015312 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015313 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015314 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015315 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15316 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15317 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15318 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015319 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015320 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015321
15322mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015323 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015324 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15325 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015326 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015327 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015328 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015329 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15330 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15331 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15332 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015333 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015334 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015335
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015336nbsrv
15337 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15338 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15339 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15340 map lookup.
15341
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015342neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015343 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15344 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15345 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15346 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015347
15348not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015349 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015350 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015351 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015352 absence of a flag).
15353
15354odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015355 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015356 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15357
15358or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015359 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015360 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015361 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15362 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015363 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015364 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15365 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15366 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15367 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015368 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015369 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015370
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015371protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15372 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15373 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15374 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15375 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15376 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15377 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15378 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15379 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15380 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15381 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15382 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15383
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015384regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015385 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15386 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15387 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15388 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15389 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15390 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15391 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15392 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15393 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015394 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15395 of characters with other ones.
15396
15397 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15398 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15399 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15400 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15401 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15402 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015403
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015404 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015405
15406 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15407 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15408 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015409 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015410
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015411 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15412 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15413
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015414 # capture groups and backreferences
15415 # both lines do the same.
15416 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
15417 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15418
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015419capture-req(<id>)
15420 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15421 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15422
15423 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015424 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15425 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015426
15427capture-res(<id>)
15428 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15429 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15430
15431 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015432 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15433 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015434
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015435rtrim(<chars>)
15436 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15437 of the input sample.
15438
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015439sdbm([<avalanche>])
15440 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15441 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15442 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15443 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15444 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15445 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15446 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015447 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15448 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015449
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015450secure_memcmp(<var>)
15451 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15452 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15453 match.
15454
15455 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15456 performed in constant time.
15457
15458 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15459 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15460
15461 Example :
15462
15463 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15464 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15465 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15466 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15467
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015468set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015469 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15470 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15471 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015472 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015473 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15474 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015475 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015476 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15477 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015478 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015479 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015480
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015481sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015482 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015483 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15484
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015485sha2([<bits>])
15486 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15487 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15488
15489 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15490 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15491
15492 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15493 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15494
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015495srv_queue
15496 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15497 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15498 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15499 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15500 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15501
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015502strcmp(<var>)
15503 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15504 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15505 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15506 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15507 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15508 shorter).
15509
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015510 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
15511 strings in constant time.
15512
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015513 Example :
15514
15515 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15516 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15517 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15518
15519
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015520sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015521 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15522 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015523 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015524 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15525 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015526 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015527 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15528 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015529 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015530 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15531 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015532 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015533 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015534
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015535table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
15536 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15537 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15538 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
15539 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15540 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15541 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
15542
15543
15544table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
15545 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15546 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15547 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
15548 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15549 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15550 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
15551
15552table_conn_cnt(<table>)
15553 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15554 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015555 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015556 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
15557 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15558
15559table_conn_cur(<table>)
15560 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15561 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15562 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15563 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15564 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
15565
15566table_conn_rate(<table>)
15567 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15568 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15569 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
15570 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15571 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
15572
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015573table_gpt0(<table>)
15574 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15575 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
15576 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15577 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15578 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
15579
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015580table_gpc0(<table>)
15581 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15582 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15583 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15584 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15585 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
15586
15587table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
15588 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15589 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15590 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
15591 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15592 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
15593 sample fetch keyword.
15594
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015595table_gpc1(<table>)
15596 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15597 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15598 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
15599 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15600 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
15601
15602table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
15603 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15604 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15605 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
15606 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15607 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
15608 sample fetch keyword.
15609
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015610table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
15611 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15612 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015613 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015614 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15615 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15616
15617table_http_err_rate(<table>)
15618 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15619 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15620 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
15621 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
15622 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
15623 keyword.
15624
15625table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
15626 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15627 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015628 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015629 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
15630 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15631
15632table_http_req_rate(<table>)
15633 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15634 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15635 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
15636 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
15637 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
15638 keyword.
15639
15640table_kbytes_in(<table>)
15641 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15642 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015643 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015644 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15645 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15646 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
15647 keyword.
15648
15649table_kbytes_out(<table>)
15650 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15651 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015652 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015653 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15654 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15655 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
15656 keyword.
15657
15658table_server_id(<table>)
15659 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15660 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15661 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
15662 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
15663 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
15664 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
15665
15666table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15667 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15668 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015669 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015670 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
15671 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15672 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
15673 keyword.
15674
15675table_sess_rate(<table>)
15676 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15677 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15678 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
15679 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
15680 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15681 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
15682 keyword.
15683
15684table_trackers(<table>)
15685 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15686 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15687 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15688 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
15689 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
15690 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
15691 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
15692 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
15693 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
15694 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
15695
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015696upper
15697 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
15698 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15699 type. The result is of type string.
15700
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020015701url_dec([<in_form>])
15702 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
15703 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
15704 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
15705 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
15706 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
15707 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020015708
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015709ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015710 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015711 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
15712 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
15713 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015714 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15715 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15716 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15717 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015718 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015719 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15720 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015721
15722 Example:
15723 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15724 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15725
15726 message Point {
15727 int32 latitude = 1;
15728 int32 longitude = 2;
15729 }
15730
15731 message PPoint {
15732 Point point = 59;
15733 }
15734
15735 message Rectangle {
15736 // One corner of the rectangle.
15737 PPoint lo = 48;
15738 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15739 PPoint hi = 49;
15740 }
15741
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015742 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
15743 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
15744 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015745
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015746 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15747 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015748 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015749 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
15750
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015751 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015752
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015753 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015754
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015755 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
15756 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15757 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015758
15759 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
15760 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
15761 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
15762
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015763 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
15764 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
15765 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015766
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015767
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010015768unset-var(<var name>)
15769 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
15770 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
15771 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
15772 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15773 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
15774 response),
15775 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15776 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
15777 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
15778 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
15779
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015780utime(<format>[,<offset>])
15781 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15782 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
15783 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15784 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15785 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15786 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
15787
15788 Example :
15789
15790 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015791 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015792 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15793
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015794word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15795 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
15796 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
15797 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015798 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015799 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
15800 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
15801
15802 Example :
15803 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
15804 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15805 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
15806 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
15807 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015808 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010015809
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015810wt6([<avalanche>])
15811 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
15812 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15813 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15814 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15815 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15816 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15817 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015818 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
15819 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015820
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015821xor(<value>)
15822 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015823 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015824 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015825 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015826 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015827 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15828 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015829 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015830 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15831 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015832 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015833 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015834
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010015835xxh32([<seed>])
15836 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
15837 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15838 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15839 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15840 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15841 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15842 as cryptographically secure.
15843
15844xxh64([<seed>])
15845 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
15846 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15847 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15848 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15849 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15850 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15851 as cryptographically secure.
15852
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015853
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200158547.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015855--------------------------------------------
15856
15857A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
15858not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
15859"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
15860The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
15861
15862always_false : boolean
15863 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15864 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15865
15866always_true : boolean
15867 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15868 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15869
15870avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015871 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015872 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
15873 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
15874 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
15875 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
15876 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
15877 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
15878 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
15879 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
15880 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
15881 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
15882 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
15883 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
15884 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010015885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015886be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015887 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
15888 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
15889 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
15890 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015891 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
15892
15893be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
15894 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15895 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
15896 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
15897 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
15898 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015899 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
15900 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015901
15902 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
15903 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
15904 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015906be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
15907 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15908 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15909 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015910 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015911 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
15912 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015913
15914 Example :
15915 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
15916 backend dynamic
15917 mode http
15918 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
15919 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015920
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015921bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015922 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
15923 of the string.
15924
15925bool(<bool>) : bool
15926 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
15927 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
15928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015929connslots([<backend>]) : integer
15930 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015931 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015932 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
15933 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050015934
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015935 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015936 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015937 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
15938
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015939 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
15940 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015941
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015942 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015943 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015944 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015945 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015946 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015947 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015948 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015949
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015950 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
15951 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015952 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015953 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015954
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015955cpu_calls : integer
15956 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
15957 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
15958 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
15959 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
15960 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
15961 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
15962
15963cpu_ns_avg : integer
15964 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15965 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15966 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15967 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15968 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15969 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15970 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
15971 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
15972 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
15973 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
15974 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15975
15976cpu_ns_tot : integer
15977 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15978 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15979 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15980 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15981 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15982 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15983 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
15984 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
15985 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
15986 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
15987 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
15988 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
15989 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
15990
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015991date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015992 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015993
15994 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
15995 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
15996 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015997 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
15998
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015999 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16000 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16001 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16002 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16003 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16004
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016005 Example :
16006
16007 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
16008 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016009
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016010 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
16011 # millisecond granularity
16012 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
16013
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010016014date_us : integer
16015 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
16016 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
16017 from the same timeval structure.
16018
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020016019distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
16020 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
16021 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
16022 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
16023 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
16024 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
16025 list of supported tokens.
16026
16027distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
16028 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
16029 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
16030 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
16031 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
16032 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
16033 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
16034 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
16035 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
16036 supported tokens.
16037
16038 Example :
16039 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
16040 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
16041 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
16042 # send large files to the big farm
16043 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
16044
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020016045env(<name>) : string
16046 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
16047 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
16048 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
16049 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
16050 certain way.
16051
16052 Examples :
16053 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
16054 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
16055
16056 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
16057 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
16058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016059fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
16060 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016061 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
16062 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016063 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
16064 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016065 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016066 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
16067 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016068
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020016069fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16070 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
16071 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
16072 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
16073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016074fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16075 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16076 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16077 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
16078 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
16079 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
16080 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
16081 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
16082 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016083
16084 Example :
16085 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
16086 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
16087 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
16088 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
16089 frontend mail
16090 bind :25
16091 mode tcp
16092 maxconn 100
16093 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
16094 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
16095 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
16096 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016097
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010016098hostname : string
16099 Returns the system hostname.
16100
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016101int(<integer>) : signed integer
16102 Returns a signed integer.
16103
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016104ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
16105 Returns an ipv4.
16106
16107ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
16108 Returns an ipv6.
16109
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016110lat_ns_avg : integer
16111 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16112 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16113 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16114 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16115 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16116 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16117 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16118 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16119 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016120 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16121 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16122 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16123 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16124 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
16125 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016126
16127lat_ns_tot : integer
16128 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16129 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16130 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16131 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16132 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16133 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16134 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16135 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16136 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016137 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16138 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16139 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16140 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16141 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016142 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
16143 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
16144 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
16145 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
16146 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
16147 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
16148
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016149meth(<method>) : method
16150 Returns a method.
16151
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016152nbproc : integer
16153 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
16154 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
16155 and debugging purposes.
16156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016157nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
16158 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
16159 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
16160 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016161 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
16162 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
16163 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016164
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040016165prio_class : integer
16166 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
16167 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
16168 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
16169
16170prio_offset : integer
16171 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
16172 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
16173 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
16174 set-priority-offset".
16175
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016176proc : integer
16177 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
16178 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
16179 debugging purposes.
16180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016181queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016182 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
16183 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
16184 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016185 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
16186 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
16187 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
16188 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
16189 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
16190
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010016191rand([<range>]) : integer
16192 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
16193 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
16194 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
16195 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
16196 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
16197
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020016198uuid([<version>]) : string
16199 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
16200 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
16201 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
16202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016203srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16204 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16205 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
16206 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16207 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16208 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016209 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16210 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16211
16212srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16213 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16214 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16215 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16216 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16217 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16218 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16219 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16220
16221 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16222 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016223
16224srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16225 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16226 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16227 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016228 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016229 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16230 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16231 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16232
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016233srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16234 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16235 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16236 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16237 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16238 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16239 fetch methods.
16240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016241srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16242 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16243 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016244 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016245 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16246 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016247 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016248 overloading servers).
16249
16250 Example :
16251 # Redirect to a separate back
16252 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16253 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16254 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16255
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020016256srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16257 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
16258 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
16259 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
16260
16261srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16262 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
16263 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16264 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
16265
16266srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16267 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
16268 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16269 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
16270
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016271stopping : boolean
16272 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16273 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16274 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16275
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016276str(<string>) : string
16277 Returns a string.
16278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016279table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16280 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16281 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16282
16283table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16284 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16285 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16286 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16287
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016288thread : integer
16289 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16290 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16291 and debugging purposes.
16292
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016293var(<var-name>) : undefined
16294 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016295 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16296 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016297 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016298 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16299 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016300 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016301 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16302 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016303 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016304 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016305
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200163067.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016307----------------------------------
16308
16309The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16310closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16311methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16312sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16313TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016314the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16315counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016316"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16317used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16318can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16319Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16320table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16321tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16322currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016323
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016324bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016325 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16326 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16327 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016329be_id : integer
16330 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016331 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16332 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016333
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016334be_name : string
16335 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016336 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16337 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016339dst : ip
16340 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16341 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16342 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16343 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016344 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16345 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16346 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16347 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16348 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16349 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016350
16351dst_conn : integer
16352 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16353 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16354 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16355 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16356 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16357 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16358 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16359 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016360
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016361dst_is_local : boolean
16362 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16363 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16364 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16365 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016366 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016367 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16368 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16369 it only once per connection.
16370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016371dst_port : integer
16372 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16373 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16374 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16375 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16376 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16377 an HTTP header.
16378
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016379fc_http_major : integer
16380 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16381 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16382 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16383
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016384fc_pp_authority : string
16385 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16386 if any.
16387
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016388fc_pp_unique_id : string
16389 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16390 if any.
16391
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016392fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16393 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16394 header.
16395
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016396fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16397 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16398 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16399 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16400 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16401 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16402 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16403
16404fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16405 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16406 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16407 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16408 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16409 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16410 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16411
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016412fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016413 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16414 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16415 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16416 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16417
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016418fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016419 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16420 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16421 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16422 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16423
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016424fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016425 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16426 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16427 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16428 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16429
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016430fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016431 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16432 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16433 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16434 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16435
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016436fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016437 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16438 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16439 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16440 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16441
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016442fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016443 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16444 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16445 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16446 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16447
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016448fe_defbe : string
16449 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16450 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016452fe_id : integer
16453 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016454 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016455 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16456
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016457fe_name : string
16458 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16459 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16460 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16461
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016462sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016463sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16464sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16465sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016466 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16467 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16468 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16469
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016470sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016471sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16472sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16473sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016474 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16475 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16476 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16477
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016478sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016479sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16480sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16481sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016482 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16483 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016484 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16485 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16486 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016487
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016488 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016489 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16490 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016491 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16492 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16493 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016494 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16495 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16496
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016497sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16498sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16499sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16500sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16501 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16502 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16503 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16504 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16505 when a first ACL was verified.
16506
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016507sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016508sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16509sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16510sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016511 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016512 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16513
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016514sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016515sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16516sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16517sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016518 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16519 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16520 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16521
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016522sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016523sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16524sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16525sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016526 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16527 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16528 See also src_conn_rate.
16529
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016530sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016531sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16532sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16533sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016534 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016535 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016536
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016537sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16538sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16539sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16540sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16541 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16542 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16543
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016544sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16545sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16546sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16547sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16548 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16549 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
16550
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016551sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016552sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16553sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16554sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016555 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
16556 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16557 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016558 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16559 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16560 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016561
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016562sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16563sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16564sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16565sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16566 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16567 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16568 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16569 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16570 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16571 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16572
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016573sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016574sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16575sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16576sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016577 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016578 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
16579 See also src_http_err_cnt.
16580
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016581sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016582sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16583sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16584sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016585 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
16586 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16587 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
16588 src_http_err_rate.
16589
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016590sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016591sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16592sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16593sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016594 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016595 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16596 src_http_req_cnt.
16597
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016598sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016599sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16600sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16601sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016602 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
16603 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
16604 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16605 src_http_req_rate.
16606
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016607sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016608sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16609sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16610sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016611 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016612 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16613 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16614 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16615 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016616
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016617 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016618 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16619 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016620 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16621
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016622sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16623sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16624sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16625sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16626 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
16627 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16628 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16629 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16630 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
16631
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016632sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016633sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16634sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16635sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016636 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
16637 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16638 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016639
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016640sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016641sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16642sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16643sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016644 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
16645 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16646 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016647
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016648sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016649sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16650sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16651sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016652 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016653 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
16654 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
16655 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016656 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016657 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
16658
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016659sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016660sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16661sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16662sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016663 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
16664 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16665 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
16666 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
16667 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016668 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016669
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016670sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016671sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16672sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16673sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020016674 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
16675 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
16676 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
16677
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016678sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016679sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16680sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16681sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016682 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16683 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016684 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016685 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
16686 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016687 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
16688 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
16689 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016691so_id : integer
16692 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
16693 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
16694 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016695
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010016696so_name : string
16697 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
16698 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
16699 strings instead of integers.
16700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016701src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016702 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016703 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
16704 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
16705 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016706 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
16707 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
16708 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016709 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
16710 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
16711 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
16712 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
16713 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
16714 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
16715 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016716
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016717 Example:
16718 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
16719 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
16720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016721src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16722 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
16723 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
16724 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016725 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016727src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16728 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
16729 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016730 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016731 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016733src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16734 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16735 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16736 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16737 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16738 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16739 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016740
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016741 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016742 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16743 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
16744 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
16745 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016746 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016747 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16748 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16749
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016750src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16751 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16752 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16753 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16754 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16755 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16756 was verified.
16757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016758src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016759 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016760 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016761 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016762 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016764src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016765 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016766 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16767 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016768 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016770src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16771 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
16772 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16773 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016774 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016776src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016777 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016778 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016779 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016780 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016781
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016782src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16783 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16784 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16785 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16786 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
16787
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016788src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16789 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16790 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16791 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16792 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
16793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016794src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016795 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016796 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016797 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16798 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016799 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16800 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16801 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016802
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016803src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16804 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16805 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16806 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16807 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16808 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16809 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16810 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016812src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016813 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016814 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016815 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016816 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016817 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016819src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16820 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
16821 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16822 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16823 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016824 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016826src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016827 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016828 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16829 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016830 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016832src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16833 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
16834 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16835 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016836 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016837 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016839src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16840 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16841 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16842 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016843 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016844 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16845 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016846
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016847 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016848 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016849 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016850 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016851
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016852src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16853 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16854 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16855 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
16856 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16857 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16858 connection when a first ACL was verified.
16859
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016860src_is_local : boolean
16861 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
16862 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
16863 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
16864 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016865 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016866 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
16867 once per connection.
16868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016869src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016870 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
16871 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
16872 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
16873 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
16874 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016876src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016877 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
16878 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16879 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
16880 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
16881 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016883src_port : integer
16884 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
16885 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
16886 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
16887 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016889src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016890 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016891 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16892 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
16893 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016894 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016896src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16897 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
16898 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16899 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16900 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016901 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016903src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16904 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
16905 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
16906 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
16907 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
16908 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
16909 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
16910 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
16911 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016912
16913 Example :
16914 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
16915 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
16916 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
16917 listen ssh
16918 bind :22
16919 mode tcp
16920 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016921 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016922 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016923 server local 127.0.0.1:22
16924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016925srv_id : integer
16926 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
16927 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016928 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020016929
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016930srv_name : string
16931 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
16932 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016933 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016934
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200169357.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016936----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020016937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016938The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
16939closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
16940when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
16941usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016942future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016943
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001694451d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
16945 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16946 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16947 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
16948 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16949 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16950
16951 Example :
16952 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
16953 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
16954 # the request.
16955 frontend http-in
16956 bind *:8081
16957 default_backend servers
16958 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16959 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16960
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016961ssl_bc : boolean
16962 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16963 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016964 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16965 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016966
16967ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
16968 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016969 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16970 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016971
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016972ssl_bc_alpn : string
16973 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
16974 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016975 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016976 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16977 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16978 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
16979 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
16980 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016981 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
16982 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016983
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016984ssl_bc_cipher : string
16985 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016986 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16987 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016988
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016989ssl_bc_client_random : binary
16990 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16991 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16992 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016993 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016994
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016995ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
16996 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16997 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016998 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
16999 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017000
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017001ssl_bc_npn : string
17002 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
17003 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017004 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017005 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
17006 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
17007 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
17008 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017009 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
17010 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017011
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017012ssl_bc_protocol : string
17013 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017014 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17015 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017016
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017017ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017018 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017019 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017020 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
17021 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017022
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017023ssl_bc_server_random : binary
17024 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17025 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17026 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017027 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017028
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017029ssl_bc_session_id : binary
17030 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
17031 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017032 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17033 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017034
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017035ssl_bc_session_key : binary
17036 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
17037 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17038 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017039 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017040
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017041ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
17042 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017043 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17044 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017046ssl_c_ca_err : integer
17047 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17048 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
17049 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
17050 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
17051 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017053ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
17054 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17055 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
17056 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
17057 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017058
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017059ssl_c_der : binary
17060 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
17061 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17062 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17063
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017064ssl_c_der_chain : binary
17065 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
17066 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17067 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17068 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17069 does not support resumed sessions.
17070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017071ssl_c_err : integer
17072 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17073 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
17074 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
17075 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
17076 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017077
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017078ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017079 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17080 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17081 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17082 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17083 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17084 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17085 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17086 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017087 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17088 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17089 LDAP v3.
17090 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17091 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017093ssl_c_key_alg : string
17094 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17095 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17096 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017098ssl_c_notafter : string
17099 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
17100 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17101 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017103ssl_c_notbefore : string
17104 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
17105 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17106 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017107
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017108ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017109 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17110 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17111 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17112 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17113 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17114 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17115 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17116 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017117 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17118 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17119 LDAP v3.
17120 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17121 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017123ssl_c_serial : binary
17124 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
17125 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17126 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017128ssl_c_sha1 : binary
17129 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
17130 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
17131 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017132 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
17133 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
17134
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017135 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017136 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017138ssl_c_sig_alg : string
17139 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17140 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17141 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017143ssl_c_used : boolean
17144 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
17145 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017147ssl_c_verify : integer
17148 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
17149 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
17150 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
17151 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017153ssl_c_version : integer
17154 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
17155 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017156
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017157ssl_f_der : binary
17158 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
17159 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17160 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17161
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017162ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017163 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17164 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17165 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17166 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017167 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017168 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17169 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17170 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017171 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17172 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17173 LDAP v3.
17174 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17175 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017177ssl_f_key_alg : string
17178 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17179 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
17180 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017182ssl_f_notafter : string
17183 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17184 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17185 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017187ssl_f_notbefore : string
17188 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17189 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17190 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017191
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017192ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017193 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17194 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17195 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17196 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17197 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17198 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17199 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17200 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017201 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17202 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17203 LDAP v3.
17204 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17205 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017207ssl_f_serial : binary
17208 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17209 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17210 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017211
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020017212ssl_f_sha1 : binary
17213 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
17214 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17215 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017217ssl_f_sig_alg : string
17218 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17219 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17220 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017222ssl_f_version : integer
17223 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17224 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17225
17226ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017227 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17228 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17229 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017231 Example :
17232 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17233 listen http-https
17234 bind :80
17235 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17236 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17237
17238ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17239 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17240 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17241
17242ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017243 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017244 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17245 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17246 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17247 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17248 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
17249 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
17250 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
17251 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
17252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017253ssl_fc_cipher : string
17254 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
17255 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020017256
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017257ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
17258 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
17259 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017260 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017261
17262ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
17263 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
17264 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017265 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017266
17267ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
17268 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
17269 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
17270 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017271 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017272 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017273
17274ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17275 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17276 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017277 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017278
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017279ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17280 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17281 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17282 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17283
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017284ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
17285 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17286 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17287 transport layer.
17288 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17289 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17290 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17291 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17292
17293ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17294 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17295 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17296 transport layer.
17297 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17298 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17299 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17300 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17301
17302ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
17303 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17304 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17305 transport layer.
17306 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17307 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17308 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17309 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17310
17311ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
17312 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17313 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17314 transport layer.
17315 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17316 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17317 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17318 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17319
17320ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
17321 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17322 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17323 transport layer.
17324 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17325 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17326 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17327 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017329ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017330 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17331 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017332 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17333 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17334 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17335 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017336
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017337ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17338 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17339 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17340 wait until the handshake happened.
17341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017342ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
17343 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017344 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
17345 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017346 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017347 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017348
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017349ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017350 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017351 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17352 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017354ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017355 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017356 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17357 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17358 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17359 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17360 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17361 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17362 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017364ssl_fc_protocol : string
17365 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17366 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017367
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017368ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017369 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017370 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17371 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017372
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017373ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17374 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17375 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17376 transport layer.
17377 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17378 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17379 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17380 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17381
17382ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
17383 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17384 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17385 transport layer.
17386 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17387 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17388 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17389 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17390
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017391ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17392 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17393 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17394 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017396ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17397 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17398 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17399 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17400 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017401
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017402ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17403 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17404 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17405 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17406 BoringSSL.
17407
17408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017409ssl_fc_sni : string
17410 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17411 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17412 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17413 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17414 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17415
17416 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17417 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17418 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017419 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017420 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017422 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017423 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17424 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017426ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17427 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17428 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017429
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017430ssl_s_der : binary
17431 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
17432 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17433 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17434
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017435ssl_s_chain_der : binary
17436 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
17437 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17438 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17439 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17440 does not support resumed sessions.
17441
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017442ssl_s_key_alg : string
17443 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17444 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
17445 SSL/TLS transport layer.
17446
17447ssl_s_notafter : string
17448 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
17449 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17450 transport layer.
17451
17452ssl_s_notbefore : string
17453 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
17454 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17455 transport layer.
17456
17457ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17458 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17459 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17460 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17461 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17462 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17463 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017464 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17465 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017466 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17467 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17468 LDAP v3.
17469 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17470 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17471
17472ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17473 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17474 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17475 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17476 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17477 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17478 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017479 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17480 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017481 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17482 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17483 LDAP v3.
17484 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17485 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17486
17487ssl_s_serial : binary
17488 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
17489 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17490 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17491
17492ssl_s_sha1 : binary
17493 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
17494 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17495 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17496
17497ssl_s_sig_alg : string
17498 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17499 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17500 layer.
17501
17502ssl_s_version : integer
17503 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
17504 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017505
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200175067.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017507------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017509Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17510sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17511only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17512For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17513be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17514can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17515sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17516for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17517content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017519payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017520 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017521 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17522 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017524payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17525 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017526 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017527 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017528
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020017529req.hdrs : string
17530 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
17531 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17532 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17533 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
17534
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020017535req.hdrs_bin : binary
17536 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17537 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
17538 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
17539 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
17540 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
17541 names and values (length of 0 for both).
17542
17543 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17544
17545 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17546 str: <int:length><bytes>
17547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017548req.len : integer
17549req_len : integer (deprecated)
17550 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17551 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17552 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17553 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17554 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17555 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17556 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
17557 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017559req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17560 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017561 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
17562 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
17563 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
17564 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017566 ACL alternatives :
17567 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017569req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17570 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17571 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17572 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
17573 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017575 ACL alternatives :
17576 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017578 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017580req.proto_http : boolean
17581req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
17582 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
17583 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
17584 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
17585 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
17586 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
17587 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
17588 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017590 Example:
17591 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
17592 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17593 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017594 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017596req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
17597rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17598 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
17599 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
17600 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
17601 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
17602 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
17603 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
17604 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017606 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
17607 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
17608 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
17609 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
17610 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
17611 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017613 ACL derivatives :
17614 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017616 Example :
17617 listen tse-farm
17618 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
17619 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
17620 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17621 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
17622 # apply RDP cookie persistence
17623 persist rdp-cookie
17624 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
17625 # This is only useful makes sense if
17626 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
17627 stick-table type string size 204800
17628 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
17629 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
17630 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017632 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
17633 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017635req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
17636rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
17637 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
17638 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
17639 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
17640 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017642 ACL derivatives :
17643 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017644
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017645req.ssl_alpn : string
17646 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
17647 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
17648 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
17649 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
17650 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
17651 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017652 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017653
17654 Examples :
17655 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17656 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17657 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017658 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017659 default_backend bk_default
17660
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017661req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
17662 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
17663 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017664 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
17665 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
17666 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
17667 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
17668 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017670req.ssl_hello_type : integer
17671req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17672 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17673 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
17674 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17675 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17676 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
17677 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17678 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017680req.ssl_sni : string
17681req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
17682 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
17683 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
17684 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
17685 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17686 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020017687 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
17688 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
17689 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
17690 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
17691 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
17692 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
17693 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
17694 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
17695 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017697 ACL derivatives :
17698 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017700 Examples :
17701 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17702 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17703 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
17704 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
17705 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017706
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053017707req.ssl_st_ext : integer
17708 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
17709 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
17710 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
17711 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
17712 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
17713 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
17714 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
17715 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
17716 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
17717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017718req.ssl_ver : integer
17719req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
17720 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
17721 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
17722 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
17723 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
17724 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17725 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17726 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017727 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017728 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017730 ACL derivatives :
17731 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017732
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017733res.len : integer
17734 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17735 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17736 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17737 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17738 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17739 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17740 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017741 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017743res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17744 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017745 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017746 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017747 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017748 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017750res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17751 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17752 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17753 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017754 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
17755 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017757 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017758
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020017759res.ssl_hello_type : integer
17760rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17761 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17762 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
17763 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17764 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17765 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
17766 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17767 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
17768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017769wait_end : boolean
17770 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
17771 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017772 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017773 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
17774 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017775 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017776 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
17777 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017779 Examples :
17780 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
17781 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
17782 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017784 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
17785 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17786 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
17787 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
17788 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
17789 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
17790 tcp-request content reject
17791
17792
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200177937.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017794--------------------------------------
17795
17796It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
17797This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
17798data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
17799its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
17800HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
17801content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
17802to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
17803more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
17804response are indexed.
17805
17806base : string
17807 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
17808 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
17809 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
17810 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
17811 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
17812 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
17813 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
17814 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
17815
17816 ACL derivatives :
17817 base : exact string match
17818 base_beg : prefix match
17819 base_dir : subdir match
17820 base_dom : domain match
17821 base_end : suffix match
17822 base_len : length match
17823 base_reg : regex match
17824 base_sub : substring match
17825
17826base32 : integer
17827 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
17828 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
17829 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017830 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
17831 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
17832 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017833
17834base32+src : binary
17835 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
17836 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
17837 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
17838 per-URL counters.
17839
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017840capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
17841 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
17842 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17843 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
17844
17845capture.req.method : string
17846 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
17847 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
17848 because it's allocated.
17849
17850capture.req.uri : string
17851 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
17852 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
17853 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
17854 allocated.
17855
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017856capture.req.ver : string
17857 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17858 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
17859 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
17860
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017861capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
17862 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
17863 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17864 The first entry is an index of 0.
17865 See also: "capture response header"
17866
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017867capture.res.ver : string
17868 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17869 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
17870 persistent flag.
17871
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017872req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017873 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
17874 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
17875 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017876
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020017877req.body_param([<name>) : string
17878 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
17879 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
17880 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
17881 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
17882 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
17883 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
17884 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
17885 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
17886 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
17887 given.
17888
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017889req.body_len : integer
17890 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
17891 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017892 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
17893 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017894
17895req.body_size : integer
17896 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017897 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17898 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017900req.cook([<name>]) : string
17901cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17902 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17903 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
17904 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
17905 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
17906 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
17907 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
17908 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
17909 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
17910
17911 ACL derivatives :
17912 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
17913 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
17914 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
17915 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
17916 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
17917 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
17918 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
17919 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017921req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17922cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17923 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17924 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017926req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17927cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17928 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17929 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
17930 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
17931 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017933cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17934 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17935 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
17936 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
17937 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017938 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017939 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
17940 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
17941 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
17942 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017944hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17945 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
17946 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
17947 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
17948 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017949 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017951req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
17952 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17953 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17954 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17955 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17956 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17957 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
17958 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
17959 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017961req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17962 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17963 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17964 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17965 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017967req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17968 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17969 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17970 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17971 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17972 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17973 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
17974 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
17975 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000017976 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017977 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017978 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017980 ACL derivatives :
17981 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17982 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17983 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17984 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17985 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17986 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17987 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17988 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17989
17990req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17991hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
17992 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17993 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
17994 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
17995 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
17996 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
17997 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
17998 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
17999 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
18000 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
18001
18002req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18003hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18004 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
18005 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
18006 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
18007 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18008 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018009 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018010 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
18011 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
18012
18013req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18014hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18015 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
18016 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
18017 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
18018 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18019 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18020 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18021 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
18022
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018023
18024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018025http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
18026 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
18027 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
18028 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18029 basic auth is supported.
18030
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018031http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
18032 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
18033 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
18034 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
18035 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018036 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18037 basic auth is supported.
18038
18039 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018040 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
18041 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
18042 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
18043 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018044
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018045http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018046 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
18047 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18048 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018049
18050http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018051 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
18052 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18053 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018054
18055http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018056 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
18057 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
18058 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018060http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018061 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
18062 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018063 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
18064 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018066method : integer + string
18067 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
18068 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
18069 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
18070 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
18071 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
18072 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
18073 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018075 ACL derivatives :
18076 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018078 Example :
18079 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
18080 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
18081 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018083path : string
18084 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
18085 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
18086 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
18087 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
18088 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018089 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018090 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018092 ACL derivatives :
18093 path : exact string match
18094 path_beg : prefix match
18095 path_dir : subdir match
18096 path_dom : domain match
18097 path_end : suffix match
18098 path_len : length match
18099 path_reg : regex match
18100 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018101
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018102query : string
18103 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
18104 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
18105 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
18106 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018107 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018108 which stops before the question mark.
18109
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018110req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18111 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18112 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18113 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
18114 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018116req.ver : string
18117req_ver : string (deprecated)
18118 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
18119 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
18120 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018122 ACL derivatives :
18123 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018124
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018125res.body : binary
18126 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
18127 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18128 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18129 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18130
18131res.body_len : integer
18132 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
18133 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18134 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18135 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18136
18137res.body_size : integer
18138 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
18139 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18140 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
18141 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
18142 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
18143 based expect rules.
18144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018145res.comp : boolean
18146 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
18147 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
18148 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018150res.comp_algo : string
18151 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
18152 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
18153 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018155res.cook([<name>]) : string
18156scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18157 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18158 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018159 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
18160 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018162 ACL derivatives :
18163 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018165res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18166scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18167 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18168 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018169 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
18170 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018172res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18173scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18174 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18175 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018176 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
18177 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018179res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18180 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18181 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18182 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18183 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18184 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
18185 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
18186 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
18187 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018188 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018190res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18191 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18192 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18193 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18194 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018195 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
18196 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018198res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18199shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
18200 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18201 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18202 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18203 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18204 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
18205 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
18206 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018207 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
18208 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018210 ACL derivatives :
18211 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18212 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18213 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18214 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18215 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18216 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18217 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18218 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18219
18220res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18221shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18222 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18223 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18224 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
18225 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018226 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018228res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18229shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18230 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
18231 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
18232 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
18233 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
18234 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018235 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
18236 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018237
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018238res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18239 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18240 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18241 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018242 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
18243 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018245res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18246shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18247 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
18248 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18249 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
18250 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
18251 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018252 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
18253 based expect rules.
18254
18255res.hdrs : string
18256 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
18257 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18258 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18259 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
18260 based expect rules.
18261
18262res.hdrs_bin : binary
18263 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18264 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
18265 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
18266 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
18267 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
18268 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
18269 (length of 0 for both).
18270
18271 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
18272
18273 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18274 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018276res.ver : string
18277resp_ver : string (deprecated)
18278 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018279 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
18280 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018282 ACL derivatives :
18283 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018285set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18286 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18287 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018288 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018289 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018291 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
18292 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018294status : integer
18295 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
18296 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018297 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
18298 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018299
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020018300unique-id : string
18301 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
18302 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
18303 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
18304 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
18305 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
18306 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
18307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018308url : string
18309 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
18310 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
18311 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
18312 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
18313 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
18314 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
18315 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018317 ACL derivatives :
18318 url : exact string match
18319 url_beg : prefix match
18320 url_dir : subdir match
18321 url_dom : domain match
18322 url_end : suffix match
18323 url_len : length match
18324 url_reg : regex match
18325 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018327url_ip : ip
18328 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
18329 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
18330 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
18331 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
18332 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
18333 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18334 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018336url_port : integer
18337 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
18338 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
18339 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18340 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018341
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018342urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
18343url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018344 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
18345 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018346 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
18347 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
18348 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
18349 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018350 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
18351 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018352 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
18353 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018355 ACL derivatives :
18356 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
18357 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
18358 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
18359 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
18360 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
18361 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
18362 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
18363 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018364
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018366 Example :
18367 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
18368 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
18369 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
18370 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018371
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018372urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018373 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
18374 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
18375 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020018376
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020018377url32 : integer
18378 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
18379 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
18380 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
18381 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
18382 is an unsigned integer.
18383
18384url32+src : binary
18385 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
18386 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
18387 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
18388
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020018389
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200183907.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018391---------------------------------------
18392
18393This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
18394used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
18395purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
18396There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
18397or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
18398any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
18399for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
18400
18401internal.htx.data : integer
18402 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
18403 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18404
18405internal.htx.free : integer
18406 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
18407 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18408
18409internal.htx.free_data : integer
18410 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
18411 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18412
18413internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
18414 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
18415 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
18416 chosen depending on the sample direction.
18417
18418internal.htx.nbblks : integer
18419 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
18420 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18421
18422internal.htx.size : integer
18423 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
18424 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18425
18426internal.htx.used : integer
18427 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
18428 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18429 direction.
18430
18431internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
18432 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18433 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
18434 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
18435 of the special value :
18436 * head : The oldest inserted block
18437 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018438 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018439
18440internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
18441 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18442 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
18443 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18444 integer or one of the special value :
18445 * head : The oldest inserted block
18446 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018447 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018448
18449internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18450 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18451 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18452 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18453 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18454
18455 * head : The oldest inserted block
18456 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018457 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018458
18459internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18460 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18461 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18462 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18463 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18464
18465 * head : The oldest inserted block
18466 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018467 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018468
18469internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18470 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18471 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18472 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18473 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18474
18475 * head : The oldest inserted block
18476 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018477 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018478
18479internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18480 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18481 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18482 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18483 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18484
18485 * head : The oldest inserted block
18486 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018487 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018488
18489internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18490 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18491 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18492 it returns false.
18493
18494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200184957.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018496---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018497
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018498Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
18499every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020018500order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018501
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018502ACL name Equivalent to Usage
18503---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018504FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020018505HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018506HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
18507HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018508HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
18509HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18510HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18511HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18512LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018513METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018514METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018515METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18516METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
18517METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
18518METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018519METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018520METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018521RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018522REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018523TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018524WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
18525---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018526
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010018527
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185288. Logging
18529----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018530
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018531One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
18532provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
18533very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
18534provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
18535state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018536to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018537headers.
18538
18539In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
18540about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
18541send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
18542
18543 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
18544 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
18545 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
18546 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
18547 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018548 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060018549 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018550
18551The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
18552allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
18553as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
18554while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
18555real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
18556delay.
18557
18558
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185598.1. Log levels
18560---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018561
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018562TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018563source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018564HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
18565in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
18566track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
18567syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
18568about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018569
18570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185718.2. Log formats
18572----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018573
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018574HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018575and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
18576slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
18577options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018578
18579 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
18580 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
18581 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
18582 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
18583 extents.
18584
18585 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
18586 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
18587 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
18588 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
18589 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
18590
18591 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
18592 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
18593 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
18594 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
18595 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
18596
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020018597 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
18598 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
18599 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
18600 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
18601
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018602 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
18603
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018604Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
18605specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
18606field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
18607servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
18608always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
18609identifier.
18610
18611Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
18612 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
18613 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
18614 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
18615 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
18616
18617
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186188.2.1. Default log format
18619-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018620
18621This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
18622as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
18623format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
18624
18625 Example :
18626 listen www
18627 mode http
18628 log global
18629 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18630
18631 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
18632 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
18633 (www/HTTP)
18634
18635 Field Format Extract from the example above
18636 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
18637 2 'Connect from' Connect from
18638 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
18639 4 'to' to
18640 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
18641 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
18642
18643Detailed fields description :
18644 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
18645 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
18646 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
18647 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
18648 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18649 and processed the connection.
18650 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
18651
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018652In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
18653"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
18654connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
18655
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018656It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
18657will eventually disappear.
18658
18659
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186608.2.2. TCP log format
18661---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018662
18663The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
18664is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
18665information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
18666counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
18667emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
18668environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
18669the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
18670sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018671specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
18672not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
18673fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
18674marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018675
18676 Example :
18677 frontend fnt
18678 mode tcp
18679 option tcplog
18680 log global
18681 default_backend bck
18682
18683 backend bck
18684 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18685
18686 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
18687 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
18688 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
18689
18690 Field Format Extract from the example above
18691 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
18692 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
18693 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
18694 4 frontend_name fnt
18695 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
18696 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
18697 7 bytes_read* 212
18698 8 termination_state --
18699 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
18700 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18701
18702Detailed fields description :
18703 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018704 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18705 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18706 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018707 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018708 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018709 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018710
18711 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018712 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18713 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18714 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018715
18716 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
18717 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
18718 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018719 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
18720 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
18721 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
18722 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018723
18724 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18725 and processed the connection.
18726
18727 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18728 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18729 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
18730 applications.
18731
18732 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18733 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18734 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18735 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
18736 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
18737
18738 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18739 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
18740 See "Timers" below for more details.
18741
18742 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18743 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
18744 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
18745 "Timers" below for more details.
18746
18747 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018748 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018749 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
18750 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
18751 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
18752 details.
18753
18754 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
18755 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
18756 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
18757 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
18758 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
18759
18760 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18761 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18762 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
18763 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
18764 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
18765 for more details.
18766
18767 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018768 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018769 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
18770 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
18771 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018772 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018773
18774 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18775 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18776 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18777 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18778 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18779 caused by a denial of service attack.
18780
18781 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18782 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18783 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18784 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18785 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18786 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18787 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18788 denial of service attack.
18789
18790 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18791 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18792 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18793 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18794 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18795 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18796 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18797 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
18798 be processed than on other servers.
18799
18800 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18801 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18802 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18803 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18804 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18805 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18806 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18807 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18808 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18809 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18810 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18811 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18812 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18813
18814 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18815 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18816 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18817 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18818 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18819 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018820 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018821 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18822
18823 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18824 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18825 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18826 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18827 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18828 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018829 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018830 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18831 occurs.
18832
18833
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188348.2.3. HTTP log format
18835----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018836
18837The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
18838is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
18839the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
18840are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
18841emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
18842generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
18843"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
18844which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018845frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
18846is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018847
18848Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
18849slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
18850with a star ('*') after the field name below.
18851
18852 Example :
18853 frontend http-in
18854 mode http
18855 option httplog
18856 log global
18857 default_backend bck
18858
18859 backend static
18860 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18861
18862 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
18863 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
18864 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018865 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018866
18867 Field Format Extract from the example above
18868 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
18869 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018870 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018871 4 frontend_name http-in
18872 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018873 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018874 7 status_code 200
18875 8 bytes_read* 2750
18876 9 captured_request_cookie -
18877 10 captured_response_cookie -
18878 11 termination_state ----
18879 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
18880 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18881 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
18882 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
18883 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018884
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018885Detailed fields description :
18886 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018887 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18888 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18889 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018890 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018891 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018892 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018893
18894 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018895 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18896 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18897 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018898
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018899 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
18900 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018901
18902 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18903 and processed the connection.
18904
18905 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18906 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18907 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
18908
18909 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18910 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18911 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18912 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
18913 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
18914 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
18915
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018916 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
18917 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
18918 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018919 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018920 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
18921 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018922 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
18923 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018924
18925 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18926 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018927 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018928
18929 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18930 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018931 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
18932 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018933
18934 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
18935 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
18936 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
18937 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
18938 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018939 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
18940 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018941
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018942 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
18943 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
18944 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
18945 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
18946 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
18947 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
18948 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018949 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018950
18951 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
18952 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
18953 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
18954
18955 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
18956 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018957 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018958 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
18959 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
18960 overflowing.
18961
18962 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
18963 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
18964 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
18965 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
18966 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
18967 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
18968 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
18969 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18970
18971 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
18972 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
18973 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
18974 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
18975 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
18976 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
18977 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
18978 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18979
18980 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18981 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18982 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
18983 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
18984 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
18985 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
18986 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
18987
18988 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018989 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018990 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
18991 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
18992 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018993 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018994 system.
18995
18996 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18997 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18998 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18999 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19000 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19001 caused by a denial of service attack.
19002
19003 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19004 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19005 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19006 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19007 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19008 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19009 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19010 denial of service attack.
19011
19012 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19013 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19014 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19015 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19016 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19017 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19018 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19019 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
19020 processed than on other servers.
19021
19022 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19023 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19024 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19025 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19026 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19027 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19028 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19029 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19030 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19031 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19032 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19033 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19034 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19035
19036 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19037 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19038 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19039 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19040 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19041 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019042 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019043 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19044
19045 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19046 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19047 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19048 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19049 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19050 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019051 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019052 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19053 occurs.
19054
19055 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
19056 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
19057 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
19058 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
19059 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
19060 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
19061 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
19062 cookies" below for more details.
19063
19064 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
19065 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
19066 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
19067 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
19068 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
19069 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
19070 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
19071 and cookies" below for more details.
19072
19073 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
19074 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
19075 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
19076 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
19077 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
19078 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
19079 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
19080 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
19081
19082
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200190838.2.4. Custom log format
19084------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019085
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019086The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019087mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019088
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019089HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019090Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
19091separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
19092prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
19093
19094Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
19095variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019096("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019097
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019098If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020019099as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019100less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
19101the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
19102
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020019103Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
19104"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
19105delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
19106preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019107
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019108Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
19109'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
19110https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
19111such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
19112
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019113Flags are :
19114 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019115 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019116 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
19117 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019118
19119 Example:
19120
19121 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
19122 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
19123
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019124 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
19125
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019126At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
19127
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019128 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
19129 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019130
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019131the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019132
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019133 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
19134 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
19135 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019136
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019137and the default TCP format is defined this way :
19138
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019139 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
19140 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019141
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019142Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
19143
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019144 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019145 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019146 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
19147 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
19148 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019149 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
19150 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
19151 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019152 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019153 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
19154 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000019155 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019156 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
19157 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010019158 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020019159 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019160 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019161 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019162 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020019163 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080019164 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019165 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
19166 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
19167 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
19168 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
19169 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019170 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019171 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019172 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019173 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019174 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019175 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
19176 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019177 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19178 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
19179 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019180 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019181 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
19182 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019183 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019184 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19185 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
19186 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020019187 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020019188 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019189 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
19190 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
19191 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
19192 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020019193 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019194 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019195 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019196 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010019197 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019198 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019199 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
19200 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
19201 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019202 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019203 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
19204 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019205 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019206 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
19207 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020019208 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019209 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019210 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019211 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019212
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019213 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019214
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019215
192168.2.5. Error log format
19217-----------------------
19218
19219When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
19220protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
19221By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
19222"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019223will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019224logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
19225
19226The format looks like this :
19227
19228 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
19229 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
19230 Connection error during SSL handshake
19231
19232 Field Format Extract from the example above
19233 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
19234 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
19235 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
19236 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
19237 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
19238
19239These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
19240failures.
19241
19242
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192438.3. Advanced logging options
19244-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019245
19246Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
19247just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
19248options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
19249for more information about their usage.
19250
19251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192528.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
19253------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019254
19255It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
19256haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
19257commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
19258monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
19259ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
19260
19261 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
19262 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
19263 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
19264 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
19265
19266 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
19267 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
19268 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019269 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019270 such as other load-balancers.
19271
19272 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
19273 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
19274 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
19275
19276
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192778.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
19278----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019279
19280The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
19281what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
19282or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019283"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019284just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
19285log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
19286after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
19287is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
19288with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
19289with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
19290
19291
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192928.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
19293------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019294
19295Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
19296for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
19297"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
19298retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
19299raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
19300a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
19301file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
19302you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
19303"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
19304
19305
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
19307--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019308
19309Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
19310multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
19311them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
19312"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
19313logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
19314error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
19315and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
19316too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
19317useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
19318alternative.
19319
19320
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193218.4. Timing events
19322------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019323
19324Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
19325reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
19326the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
19327frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019328mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
19329addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
19330
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019331Timings events in HTTP mode:
19332
19333 first request 2nd request
19334 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
19335 t tr t tr ...
19336 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
19337 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
19338 :<---- Tq ---->: :
19339 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019340 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019341 :<--------- Ta --------->:
19342
19343Timings events in TCP mode:
19344
19345 TCP session
19346 |<----------------->|
19347 t t
19348 ---|----|----|----|----|---
19349 | Th Tw Tc Td |
19350 |<------ Tt ------->|
19351
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019352 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019353 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019354 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
19355 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
19356 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019357 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019358 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
19359 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
19360 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
19361 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019362
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019363 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
19364 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
19365 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019366 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
19367 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
19368 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
19369 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
19370 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
19371 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019372
19373 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
19374 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
19375 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
19376 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
19377 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
19378 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
19379 request typed by hand during a test.
19380
19381 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
19382 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019383 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019384 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
19385 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
19386 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
19387 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019388
19389 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
19390 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
19391 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
19392 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
19393 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
19394
19395 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
19396 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
19397 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
19398 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
19399 connection never established.
19400
19401 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
19402 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
19403 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
19404 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
19405 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
19406 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
19407 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
19408 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
19409 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
19410 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
19411 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
19412
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019413 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
19414 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
19415 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
19416 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
19417 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
19418 by subtracting other timers when valid :
19419
19420 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
19421
19422 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
19423 "Ta" can never be negative.
19424
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019425 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
19426 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019427 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
19428 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019429 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019430
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019431 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019432
19433 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019434 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
19435 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019436
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019437 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
19438 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
19439 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
19440 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
19441 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
19442 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
19443 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
19444 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19445
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019446These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19447protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19448that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019449due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19450"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19451that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019452
19453Most common cases :
19454
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019455 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19456 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19457 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19458 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19459 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19460 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19461 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19462 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19463 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19464 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19465 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019466 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019467
19468 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19469 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19470 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19471 of ms on remote networks.
19472
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019473 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19474 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19475 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019476
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019477 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19478 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19479 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19480 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19481 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19482 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19483 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19484 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19485 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019486
19487Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19488
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019489 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019490 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019491 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019492
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019493 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019494 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19495 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
19496
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019497 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019498 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
19499 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
19500 flags.
19501
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019502 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
19503 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019504 Check the session termination flags, then check the
19505 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
19506 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
19507 the client connection was maintained open.
19508
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019509 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019510 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019511 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019512 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19513
19514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195158.5. Session state at disconnection
19516-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019517
19518TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19519"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
195202-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
19521each of which has a special meaning :
19522
19523 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
19524 session to terminate :
19525
19526 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
19527
19528 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
19529 server explicitly refused it.
19530
19531 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
19532 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
19533 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
19534 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019535 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019536
19537 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
19538 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019539
19540 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
19541 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
19542 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
19543 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
19544 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
19545
19546 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
19547 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
19548 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
19549 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
19550 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
19551
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090019552 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
19553 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
19554
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070019555 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
19556 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
19557 backup connections when going up.
19558
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020019559 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
19560
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019561 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
19562 send or receive data.
19563
19564 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
19565 send or receive data.
19566
19567 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
19568 with nothing left in the buffers.
19569
19570 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
19571
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010019572 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019573 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
19574
19575 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
19576 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
19577 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
19578 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
19579 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
19580
19581 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
19582 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
19583
19584 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
19585 server (HTTP only).
19586
19587 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
19588
19589 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
19590 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
19591 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
19592
19593 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
19594 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
19595 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
19596
19597 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
19598
19599 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
19600 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
19601
19602 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
19603 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
19604 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
19605
19606 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
19607 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020019608 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
19609 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019610
19611 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
19612 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
19613 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
19614 another server.
19615
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019616 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019617 server.
19618
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019619 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
19620 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
19621 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
19622 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19623
19624 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
19625 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
19626 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
19627 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19628
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020019629 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
19630 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
19631 "use-server" rule).
19632
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019633 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19634
19635 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
19636 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
19637
19638 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
19639
19640 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
19641 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
19642 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
19643
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019644 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
19645 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019646 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019647 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
19648 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
19649
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019650 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
19651
19652 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
19653 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
19654
19655 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
19656
19657 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19658
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019659The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
19660was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019661helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
19662starvation, attacks, etc...
19663
19664The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
19665alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
19666easier finding and understanding.
19667
19668 Flags Reason
19669
19670 -- Normal termination.
19671
19672 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
19673 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
19674 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
19675 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
19676
19677 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
19678 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
19679 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
19680 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
19681 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
19682 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019683
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019684 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19685 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019686 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019687
19688 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
19689 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
19690 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
19691
19692 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
19693 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
19694 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
19695 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
19696 the server takes too long to respond.
19697
19698 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
19699 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
19700 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
19701 long a time to respond.
19702
19703 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
19704 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
19705 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
19706 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019707 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
19708 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019709
19710 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
19711 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
19712 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
19713 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
19714 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020019715 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019716 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
19717 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
19718 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
19719 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
19720 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
19721 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
19722 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
19723 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019724 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019725 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
19726 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
19727 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019728
19729 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
19730 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019731 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
19732 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
19733 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
19734 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019735
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019736 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
19737 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
19738
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019739 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019740 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
19741 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019742 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019743 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
19744 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
19745
19746 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
19747 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
19748 503 or 504 here.
19749
19750 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
19751 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
19752 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
19753 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
19754 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
19755
19756 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19757 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019758 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019759 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
19760 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
19761
19762 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
19763 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
19764 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
19765 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
19766 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
19767 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
19768 between haproxy and the server.
19769
19770 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
19771 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
19772 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
19773 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
19774 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
19775 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
19776 solution is to fix the application.
19777
19778 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
19779 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
19780 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
19781 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
19782 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
19783 external attacks.
19784
19785 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
19786 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019787 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019788 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
19789 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
19790
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019791 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
19792 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
19793 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019794 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020019795 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019796
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019797 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
19798 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
19799 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
19800 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019801 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
19802 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
19803 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
19804 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
19805 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019806
19807 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
19808 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
19809 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
19810 returned an HTTP 403 error.
19811
19812 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
19813 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
19814 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
19815 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
19816
19817 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
19818 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
19819 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
19820 only be solved by proper system tuning.
19821
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019822The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
19823persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
19824important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
19825re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
19826
19827 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
19828
19829 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19830 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
19831 set on a GET request.
19832
19833 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
19834 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019835 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019836 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
19837
19838 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
19839 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
19840 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
19841
19842 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19843 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
19844 already got a cookie.
19845
19846 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19847 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
19848 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
19849 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
19850 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
19851
19852 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19853 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19854 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19855
19856 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
19857 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19858 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19859
19860 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
19861 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
19862
19863 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
19864 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
19865 then advertised in the response.
19866
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019867
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198688.6. Non-printable characters
19869-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019870
19871In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
19872consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
19873converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
19874prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
19875being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
19876escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
19877is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
19878'}' when logging headers.
19879
19880Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
19881issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
19882containing spaces is "User-Agent".
19883
19884Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
19885the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
19886performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
19887
19888
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198898.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
19890---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019891
19892Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
19893achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019894section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019895cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
19896the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
19897the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019898locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019899not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
19900user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
19901a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
19902wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
19903
19904 Examples :
19905 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
19906 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
19907
19908 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
19909 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
19910
19911
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
19913---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019914
19915Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
19916proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
19917the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
19918server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
19919
19920Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
19921response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019922section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019923
19924It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019925time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
19926appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019927are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
19928and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
19929follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
19930request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
19931in the logs.
19932
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019933As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
19934frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
19935an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
19936
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019937 Example :
19938 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
19939 listen proxy-out
19940 mode http
19941 option httplog
19942 option logasap
19943 log global
19944 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
19945
19946 # log the name of the virtual server
19947 capture request header Host len 20
19948
19949 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
19950 capture request header Content-Length len 10
19951
19952 # log the beginning of the referrer
19953 capture request header Referer len 20
19954
19955 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
19956 capture response header Server len 20
19957
19958 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
19959 capture response header Content-Length len 10
19960
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019961 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019962 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
19963
19964 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
19965 capture response header Via len 20
19966
19967 # log the URL location during a redirection
19968 capture response header Location len 20
19969
19970 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
19971 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
19972 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19973 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
19974 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
19975
19976 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19977 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19978 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19979 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019980 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019981
19982 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19983 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19984 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19985 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
19986 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019987 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019988
19989
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199908.9. Examples of logs
19991---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019992
19993These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
19994them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
19995reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
19996
19997 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
19998 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19999 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20000
20001 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
20002 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
20003
20004 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
20005 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
20006 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20007
20008 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
20009 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
20010
20011 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
20012 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20013 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
20014
20015 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020016 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020017 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
20018 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
20019
20020 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
20021 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
20022 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
20023
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020020024 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
20025 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
20026 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
20027 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
20028 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
20029 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020030
20031 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020032 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020033
20034 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
20035 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
20036 Nothing was sent to any server.
20037
20038 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
20039 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
20040
20041 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
20042 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020043 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020044 send a 408 return code to the client.
20045
20046 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
20047 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
20048
20049 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
20050 5 seconds ("c----").
20051
20052 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
20053 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020054 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020055
20056 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020057 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020058 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
20059 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
20060 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
20061 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
20062 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020063
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020020064
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200200659. Supported filters
20066--------------------
20067
20068Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
20069accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
20070unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
20071
20072See also : "filter"
20073
200749.1. Trace
20075----------
20076
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020077filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020078
20079 Arguments:
20080 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
20081 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
20082
20083 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
20084 the client and the server. By default, this filter
20085 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
20086 only parses a random amount of the available data.
20087
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020088 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020089 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
20090 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
20091 amount of the parsed data.
20092
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020093 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020094
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020095This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
20096callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
20097information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
20098filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
20099
20100Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
20101tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
20102a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
20103
20104
201059.2. HTTP compression
20106---------------------
20107
20108filter compression
20109
20110The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
20111keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020112when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
20113fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
20114done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
20115explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
20116filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
20117listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20118order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020119
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020120See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
20121 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020122
20123
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200201249.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
20125--------------------------------------------
20126
20127filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
20128
20129 Arguments :
20130
20131 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
20132 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
20133 parsed.
20134
20135 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
20136 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
20137 part must be placed in its own scope.
20138
20139The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
20140external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020141streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020142exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
20143also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
20144
20145SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
20146the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
20147
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020148For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020149"doc/SPOE.txt".
20150
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100201519.4. Cache
20152----------
20153
20154filter cache <name>
20155
20156 Arguments :
20157
20158 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
20159
20160The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
20161"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020162cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020163other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
20164case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
20165is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
20166filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010020167listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20168order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010020169
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020170See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
20171 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
20172
20173
201749.5. Fcgi-app
20175-------------
20176
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020177filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020178
20179 Arguments :
20180
20181 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
20182
20183The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
20184request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
20185reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
20186used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
20187implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
20188used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
20189fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
20190used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20191order.
20192
20193See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
20194 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
20195
20196
2019710. FastCGI applications
20198-------------------------
20199
20200HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
20201feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
20202the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
20203FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
20204servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
20205FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
20206backend.
20207
20208HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
20209application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
20210connection.
20211
2021210.1. Setup
20213-----------
20214
2021510.1.1. Fcgi-app section
20216--------------------------
20217
20218fcgi-app <name>
20219 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
20220 document root must be defined.
20221
20222acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
20223 Declare or complete an access list.
20224
20225 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
20226 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
20227 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
20228 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
20229 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
20230
20231docroot <path>
20232 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
20233 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
20234 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
20235
20236index <script-name>
20237 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
20238 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
20239 is an optional setting.
20240
20241 Example :
20242 index index.php
20243
20244log-stderr global
20245log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
20246 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
20247 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
20248
20249 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
20250 default STDERR messages are ignored.
20251
20252pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20253 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
20254 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
20255 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20256
20257 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
20258 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
20259 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
20260 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
20261
20262 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
20263 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
20264
20265path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020266 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020267 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
20268 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
20269 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
20270 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
20271 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
20272 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
20273 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020274
20275 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020276 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020277 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
20278 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
20279 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
20280 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020281
20282 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020283 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
20284 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020285
20286option get-values
20287no option get-values
20288 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
20289
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020290 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020291 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
20292
20293 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
20294 application will accept.
20295
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020020296 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
20297 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020298
20299 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050020300 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020301 option is disabled.
20302
20303 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
20304 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
20305 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
20306 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
20307 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
20308 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
20309
20310option keep-conn
20311no option keep-conn
20312 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
20313 sending a response.
20314
20315 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
20316 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
20317
20318option max-reqs <reqs>
20319 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
20320 accept.
20321
20322 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
20323 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
20324 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
20325 to 1.
20326
20327option mpxs-conns
20328no option mpxs-conns
20329 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
20330
20331 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
20332 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
20333
20334set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20335 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
20336 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
20337 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
20338 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20339
20340 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
20341 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
20342 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
20343
20344 Example :
20345 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
20346 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
20347
20348 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
20349
20350
2035110.1.2. Proxy section
20352---------------------
20353
20354use-fcgi-app <name>
20355 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
20356
20357 Arguments :
20358 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
20359
20360 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
20361 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
20362 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
20363 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
20364 application may be defined at a time per backend.
20365
20366 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
20367 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
20368 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
20369 application are evaluated.
20370
20371
2037210.1.3. Example
20373---------------
20374
20375 frontend front-http
20376 mode http
20377 bind *:80
20378 bind *:
20379
20380 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
20381 default_backend back-static
20382
20383 backend back-static
20384 mode http
20385 server www A.B.C.D:80
20386
20387 backend back-dynamic
20388 mode http
20389 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
20390 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
20391
20392 fcgi-app php-fpm
20393 log-stderr global
20394 option keep-conn
20395
20396 docroot /var/www/my-app
20397 index index.php
20398 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
20399
20400
2040110.2. Default parameters
20402------------------------
20403
20404A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
20405the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020406script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020407applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
20408
20409 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20410 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
20411 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
20412 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
20413 | | |
20414 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20415 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
20416 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
20417 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
20418 | | application. |
20419 | | |
20420 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20421 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
20422 | | the request. It may not be set. |
20423 | | |
20424 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20425 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
20426 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
20427 | | the application's configuration. |
20428 | | |
20429 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20430 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
20431 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
20432 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
20433 | | |
20434 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20435 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
20436 | | following the part that identifies the script |
20437 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
20438 | | be defined. |
20439 | | |
20440 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20441 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
20442 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
20443 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
20444 | | is not set too. |
20445 | | |
20446 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20447 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20448 | | set. |
20449 | | |
20450 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20451 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20452 | | the request. |
20453 | | |
20454 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20455 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20456 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20457 | | |
20458 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20459 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20460 | | script to process the request. |
20461 | | |
20462 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20463 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20464 | | |
20465 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20466 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20467 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20468 | | |
20469 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20470 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20471 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20472 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20473 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20474 | | |
20475 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20476 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20477 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20478 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20479 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20480 | | side. |
20481 | | |
20482 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20483 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20484 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20485 | | connected to. |
20486 | | |
20487 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20488 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20489 | | |
20490 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20491 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20492 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20493 | | |
20494 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20495
20496
2049710.3. Limitations
20498------------------
20499
20500The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
20501way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
20502during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
20503establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
20504application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
20505or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
20506message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
20507these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20508and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20509
20510Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20511request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20512requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20513
20514About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20515into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20516fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20517"http-request" ones.
20518
20519Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20520FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20521processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20522must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
20523here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010020524
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020525/*
20526 * Local variables:
20527 * fill-column: 79
20528 * End:
20529 */